Field of the invention
[0001] The invention relates to compounds, combinations, and kits for the cleaving of imaging
or radiotherapy labels from (bio)molecules in a subject, such as (bio)molecules that
are administered to said subject for purposes such as targeted imaging and targeted
radiotherapy.
Background of the invention
[0002] In many areas of medical diagnostics, imaging and radiotherapy, it is desired to
selectively deliver an agent, such as a radiotherapeutic agent or a diagnostic (e.g.
imaging) agent, to a specific site, or a confined region, in the body of a subject
such as a patient. Targeting of an organ or a tissue is typically achieved by the
conjugation of the desired imaging or radiotherapy label (i.e. a radionuclide) to
a targeting agent, which binds to cell surfaces or promotes cellular uptake at or
near the target site of interest. The targeting agents used to target such labels
are typically constructs that have affinity for cell surface targets (e.g., membrane
receptors), structural proteins (e.g., amyloid plaques), or intracellular targets
(e.g., RNA, DNA, enzymes, cell signaling pathways). These targeting agents can be
antibodies (and fragments), proteins, aptamers, oligopeptides, oligonucleotides, oligosaccharides,
as well as peptides, peptoids and organic drug compounds known to accumulate at a
particular disease or malfunction. Alternatively, an imaging or radiotherapy agent
may target a metabolic pathway, which is upregulated during a disease (like infection
or cancer) such as DNA, protein, and membrane synthesis and carbohydrate uptake. In
diseased tissues, abovementioned markers can discriminate diseased cells from healthy
tissue and offer unique possibilities for early detection, specific diagnosis and
(targeted) therapy.
[0003] As radio-imaging and radiotherapeutic agents (i.e. nuclear imaging and therapy agents)
comprise radionuclides, which are radioactive, it is desired to quickly, efficiently,
and/or conveniently reduce the amount of radionuclides in a patient once its therapeutic
and/or imaging purposes are fulfilled. For example, this will enable reducing the
dose of potentially harmful radiation given to the whole body. Also, in the context
of imaging, clearing the radionuclides from the patient as quickly as possible after
the imaging procedure, allows starting another imaging procedure in the same patient
of the same or a different imaging target (i.e. image cycling). Natural clearance,
however, is very slow.
[0004] Furthermore, an important criterion for successful imaging/therapy agents in general
and nuclear imaging/therapy agents in particular is that they exhibit a high target
uptake while showing an efficient clearance (through renal and/or hepatobiliary systems)
from non-target tissues and from the blood. However, this is often problematic, especially
when using antibodies. For example, imaging studies in humans have shown that the
maximum concentration of a radiolabeled antibody at the tumor site is attainable within
24 h but several more days are required before the concentration of the labeled antibody
in circulation decreases to levels low enough for successful imaging to take place.
In the context of radioimmunotherapy (RIT), the slow antibody clearance from blood
results in high radiation doses to
e.g. the bone marrow limiting the amount of radioactivity that can be safely administered,
limiting the therapeutic effect.
[0005] Further, targeted imaging (e.g. optical or nuclear) or radiotherapy can be hampered
by circulating fractions of the receptor that is being targeted, and which can capture
the imaging or radiotherapy agents before they can reach the target receptor at the
target cell surface, negatively impacting target-background ratios.
[0006] In addition, off target uptake of imaging agents (e.g. in the liver) can obscure
the target uptake.
[0007] Effectively, the targeting process can be divided into three processes:
- (I) the administration process, in which the compound comprising a targeting agent
is administered to a subject, and a fraction of said compound binds to the target;
- (II) the clearance process, wherein the fraction of the compound comprising a targeting
agent that circulates in the blood (rather than being bound to the target) is cleared
(i.e. removed by excretion) from the blood and other non-target tissues;
- (III) the imaging/therapy process, wherein the compound comprising a targeting agent
present in the subject is used for imaging or therapy purposes.
[0008] It will be understood that the tumor-to-blood (T/B) ratios are increased in process
(I) due to targeting, viz. the labelled compound accumulates at the targeted site,
in this case a tumor.
[0009] For process (III), the TIE ratio should be sufficiently high, so that the fraction
of circulating administered compound or compound bound to non-target tissues does
not interfere with the imaging/therapy. Typically, this is achieved by waiting for
an undesired long time during process (II), for reasons given above.
[0010] In general, it is desired to have methods to increase target-non target ratio of
imaging or radiotherapy agents in the abovementioned process (II) more quickly, and
to have temporal and spatial control over the action of those agents.
[0011] The poor T/B ratios for antibodies have led to pre-targeting approaches to improve
image quality in radioimmunoimaging and to increase the therapeutic index in RIT.
The long-circulating monoclonal antibody (mAb) is administered first, allowed to bind
the tumor and slowly clear from circulation, after which a small radiolabeled probe
is injected. This probe binds the tumor-bound antibody or otherwise rapidly clears
from circulation, leading to improved TIE ratios.
[0012] Typically, a clearing agent is administered prior to injection of the probe, to clear
any freely circulating antibody from blood, resulting in further improved TIE ratios
[
F.C. van de Watering et al., Front. Med. 2014, 1, 44]. However, pretargeting can typically only be used with non-internalizing receptors,
and is relatively complex, requiring the optimization of dosing and timing for three
agents.
[0013] An alternative approach is to administer a clearing agent to remove a radiolabeled
antibody from circulation after sufficient amounts have bound the target, but this
has not worked well in the clinic and gives high radiation doses to the liver [
R.H.J. Begent et al., Br. J. Cancer 1989, 60, p. 406-412].
[0014] Another approach is to cleave the radiolabel from freely circulating antibody after
sufficient amounts of radiolabeled antibody have bound and internalized in the target
cells by of administering an enzyme designed to cleave the bond between antibody and
label. However, the enzymatic cleavage method was rather slow and inefficient, giving
only 3-fold improvements in TIE ratios [
Q. Ren et al., Mol. Pharm. 2019, 16, p. 1065-1073]. In addition, three injections with the enzyme were typically required, which makes
it an inconvenient method.
[0015] Another background reference is
WO 2014/081303 A1 which discloses conjugates comprising trans-cyclooctene-derived groups which can
be cleaved by reaction with a diene. Z
[0016] It is a desire to provide compounds and/or a combination of compounds that enables
to quickly reduce the amount of radionuclides in a patient, e.g. after radioimaging
is completed. It is also desired that a compound and/or a combination of compounds
be provided that enables an increase of the target-non target ratio of imaging or
radiotherapy agents in the clearance process. It is also desired that this increase
is obtained faster than in known methods. Furthermore, it is desired to provide a
compound and/or a combination of compounds that enables temporal and spatial control
over the action of those agents. In addition, it is desired that this compound and/or
a combination of compounds is versatile, rapid, efficient, and/or convenient.
Summary of the invention
[0017] The invention, in one aspect, pertains to a compound satisfying Formula (1):

and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein
the compound of Formula (1) comprises at least one Label and at least one Administration
Agent;
the Label is a moiety comprising a radionuclide;
the Administration Agent is an antibody, wherein the term "antibody" refers to an
antibody, an antibody fragment which is at least a portion of the variable region
of the immunoglobulin that binds to its target, or an antibody mimetic;
each X1, X2, X3, X4 is independently selected from the group consisting of -C(R47)2-, -NR37-, -C(O)-, -O-, such that at most two of X1, X2, X3, X4 are not -C(R47)2-, and with the proviso that no sets consisting of adjacent atoms are present selected
from the group consisting of -O-O-, -O-N-, -C(O)-O-, N-N-, and -C(O)-C(O)-;
X5 is -C(R47)2- or -CHR48, preferably X5 is -C(R47)2-;
each R48 is independently selected from the group consisting of -LB, and -LA; preferably R48 is -LB;
R48 is bound to the remainder of the compound of Formula (1) via a part of R48 that is -O-, -S-, -OC(O)-, -OC(S)-, -SC(O)-, or -SC(S)-;
LB is a moiety satisfying Formula (2):

wherein
the dashed line denotes a bond to the remainder of the compound of Formula (1); SL is a linker, which optionally is a self-immolative linker LC;
each R98 individually is the Label or a clearance-directing group, wherein a clearance-directing
group is a moiety that directs a compound to an excretory organ;
each d independently is 0 or 1;
e is an integer in a range of from 0 to 4, preferably e is 0;
LA is a moiety satisfying Formula (3):


wherein
the dashed line denotes a bond to the remainder of the compound of Formula (1); each
s is independently 0 or 1; preferably each s is 0;
i is an integer in a range of from 0 to 4, preferably 0 or 1, most preferably 0;
each SP independently is a spacer, which optionally is a self-immolative linker LC; AA denotes the Administration Agent;
CC denotes a Construct-C, wherein each Construct-C is independently selected from the
group consisting of a Label and an Administration Agent; preferably the compound of
Formula (1) comprises at most one CC;
provided that LA only comprises both the Label and the Administration Agent when LA is R48;
provided that if LA being R48 comprises both the Label and the Administration Agent, then the SP linked to said Label and said Administration Agent is a self-immolative linker, wherein
said Label and said Administration Agent will be uncoupled after reaction of the compound
of Formula (1) with a Cleaving Agent due to the self-immolative character of the linker,
wherein the Cleaving Agent is a diene;
each R47 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, -LB, -LA, -(SP)i-CC, -F, -Cl, -Br, -I, -OR37, -N(R37)2, -SO3, -PO3-, -NO2, - CF3, -SR37, S(=O)2N(R37)2, OC(=O)R37, SC(=O) R37, OC(=S)R37, SC(=S)R37, NR37C(=O)-R37, NR37C(=S)-R37, NR37C(=O)O-R37, NR37C(=S)O-R37, NR37C(=O)S-R37, NR37C(=S)S-R37, OC(=O)N(R37)2, SC(=O)N(R37)2, OC(=S)N(R37)2, SC(=S)N(R37)2, NR37C(=O)N(R37)2, NR37C(=S)N(R37)2, C(=O)R37, C(=S)R37, C(=O)N(R37)2, C(=S)N(R37)2, C(=O)O-R37, C(=O)S-R37, C(=S)O-R37, C(=S)S-R37, S(O)R37, -S(O)2R37, NR37S(O)2R37, -ON(R37)2, .NR37OR37, C1-C24 alkyl groups, C2-C24 alkenyl groups, C2-C24 alkynyl groups, C6-C24 aryl groups, C2-C24 heteroaryl groups, C3-C24 cycloalkyl groups, C5-C24 cycloalkenyl groups, C12-C24 cycloalkynyl groups, C3-C24 (cyclo)alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C3-C24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkyl, C4-C24 (cyclo)alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C4-C24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkenyl groups, C4-C24 (cyclo)alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C4-C24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkynyl groups, C4-C24 alkylcycloalkyl groups, and C4-C24 cycloalkylalkyl groups; wherein i is an integer in a range of from 0 to 4, preferably
i is an integer ranging from 0 to 1,
wherein the alkyl groups, alkenyl groups, alkynyl groups, aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl
groups, cycloalkenyl groups, cycloalkynyl groups, (cyclo)alkyl(hetero)aryl groups,
(hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkyl groups, (cyclo)alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkenyl
groups, (cyclo)alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkynyl groups, alkylcycloalkyl
groups, cycloalkylalkyl groups are optionally substituted with a moiety selected from
the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OR37, -N(R37)2, - SO3R37, -PO3(R37)2, -PO4(R37)2, -NO2, -CF3, =O, =NR37, and -SR37, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of O, S, NR37, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized,
wherein the N atoms are optionally quaternized;
two R47 and/or R37 are optionally comprised in a ring,
two R47 and/or R37 are optionally comprised in a ring so as to form a ring fused to the eight membered
trans-ring of Formula (1);
each R37 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, -LB, - LA, -(SP)i-CC, C1-C24 alkyl groups, C2-C24 alkenyl groups, C2-C24 alkynyl groups, C6-C24 aryl groups, C2-C24 heteroaryl groups, C3-C24 cycloalkyl groups, C5-C24 cycloalkenyl groups, C12-C24 cycloalkynyl groups, C3-C24 (cyclo)alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C3-C24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkyl, C4-C24 (cyclo)alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C4-C24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkenyl groups, C4-C24 (cyclo)alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C4-C24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkynyl groups, C4-C24 alkylcycloalkyl groups, and C4-C24 cycloalkylalkyl groups; wherein i is an integer in a range of from 0 to 4, preferably
i is 1;
the R37 groups not being hydrogen are optionally substituted with a moiety selected from
the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH2, -SO3H, -PO3H, - PO4H2, -NO2, -CF3, =O, =NH, and -SH, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the
group consisting of O, S, NH, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally
oxidized, wherein the N atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0018] In another aspect, the invention relates to a combination comprising the compound
according to Formula (1), and a Cleaving Agent, with the proviso that when at least
one R
48 in Formula (1) comprises a Label, then the Cleaving Agent does not comprise the same
Label as R
48; with the proviso that when at least one R
48 in Formula (1) comprises an Administration Agent, then the Cleaving Agent does not
comprise the same Administration Agent as R
48;
wherein the Cleaving Agent is a diene.
[0019] In yet another aspect, the invention pertains to the compound according to Formula
(1), or the combination according to the invention for use as a medicament.
[0020] In yet another aspect, the invention relates to the compound according to Formula
(1), or the combination according to the invention, for use in the treatment of a
disease, preferably cancer, in a subject, preferably a human, wherein the treatment
is radiotherapy.
[0021] In a further aspect still, the invention relates to the compound according to Formula
(1), or the combination according to the invention, for use in a diagnostic method
comprising the steps of
- (a) administering a compound according to Formula (1) as defined herein, to a subject,
preferably a human;
- (b) administering a Cleaving Agent as defined herein, to said subject;
- (c) imaging the compound according to Formula (1) present in the subject to collect
data;
- (d) comparing said data to standard values;
- (e) finding a significant deviation from said standard values during comparison;
- (f) attributing the significant deviation to a particular clinical picture, preferably
to cancer.
[0022] In yet another aspect, the invention pertains to a non-therapeutic method for imaging
a compound according to Formula (1) in a subject, preferably a human wherein the following
steps have been performed on the subject:
- (a) administering a compound according to Formula (1) as defined herein, to the subject;
- (b) administering a Cleaving Agent as defined herein, to said subject;
wherein the non-therapeutic method comprises the step of:
(c) imaging the compound according to Formula (1) present in the subject.
[0023] In yet a further aspect, the invention relates to a use of a compound according to
Formula (1), or a combination according to the invention, for imaging in a subject,
preferably a human.
Brief Description of the Figures
[0024]
Figure 1. General scheme depicting the use of the invention in radioimmunotherapy. A radiolabelled
antibody is administered, allowed to circulate and bind an internalizing cancer receptor,
and after sufficient internalization has occurred a Cleaving Agent is administered
that cleaves the radiolabel (e.g. a moiety comprising a radiometal-chelate complex)
from the antibody, resulting in rapid renal clearance of the radioactivity from blood
and non-target tissues, but not of the tumor cell-internalized radioactivity.
Figure 2. Radioactivity profiles in blood in mice injected with a mAb-trigger-Label
conjugate followed by a Cleaving Agent or by vehicle. The Cleaving Agent is administered
one hour or 24 hours post-mAb injection. The figure shows rapid clearance of the Label
from blood upon trigger reaction with the Cleaving Agent in vivo.
Detailed Description of the Invention
[0025] In a broad sense, the invention pertains to the judicious recognition that compounds
according to Formula (1), and combinations and kits as defined herein, better address
one or more of the abovementioned desires. The compounds, combinations, and kits of
the invention can be used to quickly lower the amount of radionuclides in a subject.
In particular, the compounds, combinations, and kits of the invention can be used
to increase the target-non target ratio of imaging or radiotherapy agents in the clearance
process, and more particularly to reach such an increase more rapidly.
[0026] The invention, in one aspect, presents the concept of administering a compound according
to Formula (1) comprising a label (a moiety comprising a radionuclide) and an Administration
Agent, and subsequently administering a Cleaving Agent comprising a diene in the clearance
phase, said dienophile and diene being capable of undergoing a bio-orthogonal reaction
with each other, resulting in the decoupling of the label from the Administration
Agent, preferably at specifically the non-targeted site
(e.g. the blood), and the efficient clearance of the released label from circulation and
other non-target tissues, and/or the body as a whole. An Administration Agent is to
be understood as any antibody, in particular those of which it is desired to image
its biodistribution or target binding in vivo, or which is used as a targeting agent
for therapeutic radiation.
[0027] This bio-orthogonal reaction is very fast, and readily results in good release of
the moiety comprising a radionuclide. Typically, high release yields are obtained
after only one administration of the Cleaving Agent, making the method efficient,
and convenient for both the patient and the medical practitioner.
[0028] Thus, preferably the cleavage of the label from the compound of Formula (1) pertains
to the fraction present in, or bound to non-target tissues while the portion bound
to target tissues is not cleaved or does not lead to accelerated clearance.
[0029] The fact that the inverse electron demand Diels-Alder (IEDDA) reaction can be used
in the abovementioned applications is surprising. Firstly, the IEDDA reaction has
never been used to lower the amount of radionuclides in a subject. Instead, the IEDDA
reaction has typically been used to specifically release a drug at a target site,
after which the drug entered a cell, a tumor, and the like. Thus, this does not relate
to radionuclides, and speaks against ways to quickly remove the released agent from
the body. In addition, previously the IEDDA reaction was used to specifically release
a drug at the target site specifically
after the clearance process. Moreover, the IEDDA reaction was used in applications wherein
no release occurs, but a clearance-directing group is used to remove the Administration
Agent from circulation. By contrast, the present invention is based on the judicious
insight that with the compounds and combinations of the invention, decoupling of a
label and the Administration Agent occurs, preferably in the blood and other non-target
sites, after which specifically the label is rapidly cleared (Figure 1).
[0030] Without wishing to be bound by theory, the inventors believe that an antibody comprised
in the compounds of Formula (1) has a relatively slow clearance rate due large size
and/or the binding to biomolecules and much larger structures, such as cells, which
greatly reduces the clearance rate of the compound of Formula (1). By addition of
a Cleaving Agent, the moiety comprising a radionuclide is released. Said moiety is
by definition smaller than the compound of Formula (1), and has no specific affinity
for any biomolecule and thus typically does not bind to such a biomolecule. The inventors
believe that for at least these reasons, the released moiety is cleared much faster
than the compound of Formula (1).
[0031] Specifically, when the Administration Agent is an intact IgG antibody, this antibody
will clear very slowly from blood due to FcRn-mediated recycling. In addition, or
alternatively, Administration Agents may bind to a Primary Target present in blood
(e.g. on a blood cell or a shed receptor from a tumor) or other biomolecules (e.g.
serum albumin) and tissues, target tissues and non-target tissues, and as a result
clear slowly from the body as a whole, from the target tissues or from the non-target
tissues. Also, proteins in general, including antibodies, can clear slowly due to
relatively large size. On the contrary, the released moiety comprising a radionuclide
is generally cleared fast, as it is much smaller and typically has low affinity to
biomolecules and tissues. Reference is made to [
Orcutt et al, Mol Imaging Biol. 2011, 215-221] demonstrating the fast clearance of radiolabeled chelate derivatives.
[0032] Thus, in some embodiments, a compound of Formula (1) comprising a label, particularly
a radiolabeled chelate, and an Administration Agent, will be administered for the
purpose of being targeted to and internalized by a certain tissue in the body, e.g.
a tumor cell receptor or a brain target (Figure 1). Subsequent injection of Cleaving
Agent, preferably a non-internalizing (i.e. not cell permeable) Cleaving Agent, results
in release of the radiolabeled chelate from Administration Agent in circulation and
its rapid excretion, while any released chelate inside the target cell will not be
excreted, leading to increased target-non-target (T-NT) ratios, that in particular
are achieved more rapidly than with known methods.
[0033] In other embodiments, the compound of Formula (1) targets a non-internalizing receptor
in a tissue. Then, preferably the Cleaving Agent is chosen such that it does not significantly
extravasate from blood into other tissues, to enable specific release of the Label
in the blood,
i.e. off-target.
[0034] The compound of Formula (1) can be specifically designed as an imaging agent of a
particular target or process in vivo, such as in the case of radioimmunoimaging. It
can also be specifically designed to deliver therapeutic radiation to a particular
target in vivo, such as in the case of radioimmunotherapy.
[0035] A Cleaving Agent is an agent or compound that is administered to a subject for the
purpose of cleaving the label from the Administration Agent resulting in a different
biodistribution and pharmacokinetics of the released label compared to the label when
bound to the Administration Agent. The released label has a much faster blood clearance
than the compound of Formula (1) and/or the released label has a much lower retention
in one or more non-target tissues such as epithelial cells, fat, muscle, and kidney
and RES organs such as liver and spleen, than the compound of Formula (1).
[0036] The concept of cleaving a compound of Formula (1) in vivo is of general relevance
in targeted radiotherapy and imaging.
Definitions
[0037] The present invention will further be described with respect to particular embodiments
and with reference to certain drawings but the invention is not limited thereto but
only by the claims. Any reference signs in the claims shall not be construed as limiting
the scope. The drawings described are only schematic and are non-limiting. In the
drawings, the size of some of the elements may be exaggerated and not drawn on scale
for illustrative purposes. Where an indefinite or definite article is used when referring
to a singular noun e.g. "a" or "an", "the", this includes a plural of that noun unless
something else is specifically stated. The verb "to comprise", and its conjugations,
as used in this description and in the claims is used in its non-limiting sense to
mean that items following the word are included, but items not specifically mentioned
are not excluded. Thus, the scope of the expression "a device comprising means A and
B" should not be limited to devices consisting only of components A and B. It means
that with respect to the present invention, the only relevant components of the device
are A and B.
[0038] In addition, reference to an element by the indefinite article "a" or "an" does not
exclude the possibility that more than one of the element is present, unless the context
clearly requires that there is one and only one of the elements. The indefinite article
"a" or "an" thus usually means "at least one".
[0039] The compounds disclosed in this description and in the claims may comprise one or
more asymmetric centres, and different diastereomers and/or enantiomers may exist
of the compounds. The description of any compound in this description and in the claims
is meant to include all diastereomers, and mixtures thereof, unless stated otherwise.
In addition, the description of any compound in this description and in the claims
is meant to include both the individual enantiomers, as well as any mixture, racemic
or otherwise, of the enantiomers, unless stated otherwise. When the structure of a
compound is depicted as a specific enantiomer, it is to be understood that the invention
of the present application is not limited to that specific enantiomer, unless stated
otherwise. When the structure of a compound is depicted as a specific diastereomer,
it is to be understood that the invention of the present application is not limited
to that specific diastereomer, unless stated otherwise.
[0040] The compounds may occur in different tautomeric forms. The compounds according to
the invention are meant to include all tautomeric forms, unless stated otherwise.
When the structure of a compound is depicted as a specific tautomer, it is to be understood
that the invention of the present application is not limited to that specific tautomer,
unless stated otherwise.
[0041] The compounds disclosed in this description and in the claims may further exist as
exo and endo diastereomers. Unless stated otherwise, the description of any compound
in the description and in the claims is meant to include both the individual exo and
the individual endo diastereomers of a compound, as well as mixtures thereof. When
the structure of a compound is depicted as a specific endo or exo diastereomer, it
is to be understood that the invention of the present application is not limited to
that specific endo or exo diastereomer, unless stated otherwise.
[0042] Unless stated otherwise, the compounds of the invention and/or groups thereof may
be protonated or deprotonated. It will be understood that it is possible that a compound
may bear multiple charges which may be of opposite sign. For example, in a compound
containing an amine and a carboxylic acid, the amine may be protonated while simultaneously
the carboxylic acid is deprotonated.
[0043] The present invention also provides a combination of a compound of Formula (1) and
a Cleaving Agent. The term "combination" is to be understood in broad sense, not limited
to a kit comprising both components. Thus, the compound of Formula (1) and the Cleaving
Agent can be provided totally separately of each other. It will be understood that
the function of the Cleaving Agent in particular is to act in combination with a compound
of Formula (1).
[0044] In several formulae, groups or substituents are indicated with reference to letters
such as "A", "B", "X", "Y", and various (numbered) "R" groups. In addition, the number
of repeating units may be referred to with a letter, e.g. n in -(CH
2)
n-. The definitions of these letters are to be read with reference to each formula,
i.e. in different formulae these letters, each independently, can have different meanings
unless indicated otherwise.
[0045] In several chemical formulae and texts below reference is made to "alkyl", "heteroalkyl",
"aryl", "heteroaryl", "alkenyl", "alkynyl", "alkylene", "alkenylene", "alkynylene",
"arylene", "cycloalkyl", "cycloalkenyl", "cycloakynyl", arenetriyl, and the like.
The number of carbon atoms that these groups have, excluding the carbon atoms comprised
in any optional substituents as defined herein, can be indicated by a designation
preceding such terms (e.g. "C
1-C
8 alkyl" means that said alkyl may have from 1 to 8 carbon atoms). For the avoidance
of doubt, a butyl group substituted with a -OCH
3 group is designated as a C
4 alkyl, because the carbon atom in the substituent is not included in the carbon count.
[0046] Unsubstituted alkyl groups have the general formula C
nH
2n+i and may be linear or branched. Optionally, the alkyl groups are substituted by one
or more substituents further specified in this document. Examples of alkyl groups
include methyl, ethyl, propyl, 2-propyl, t-butyl, 1-hexyl, 1-dodecyl, etc. Unless
stated otherwise, an alkyl group optionally contains one or more heteroatoms independently
selected from the group consisting of O, NR
36, S, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized and the N atoms
are optionally quaternized. In preferred embodiments, up to two heteroatoms may be
consecutive, such as in for example -CH
2-NH-OCH
3 and -CH
2-O-Si(CH
3)
3. In some preferred embodiments the heteroatoms are not directly bound to one another.
Examples of heteroalkyls include -CH
2CH
2-O-CH
3, -CH
2CH
2-NH-CH
3, - CH
2CH
2-S(O)-CH
3, -CH-CH-O-CH
3, -Si(CH
3)
3. In preferred embodiments, a C
1-C
4 alkyl contains at most 2 heteroatoms.
[0047] A cycloalkyl group is a cyclic alkyl group. Unsubstituted cycloalkyl groups comprise
at least three carbon atoms and have the general formula C
nH
2n-1 Optionally, the cycloalkyl groups are substituted by one or more substituents further
specified in this document. Examples of cycloalkyl groups include cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl,
cyclopentyl and cyclohexyl. Unless stated otherwise, a cycloalkyl group optionally
contains one or more heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting
of O, NR
36, S, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized and the N atoms
are optionally quaternized.
[0048] An alkenyl group comprises one or more carbon-carbon double bonds, and may be linear
or branched. Unsubstituted alkenyl groups comprising one C-C double bond have the
general formula C
nH
2n-1 Unsubstituted alkenyl groups comprising two C-C double bonds have the general formula
C
nH
2n-3. An alkenyl group may comprise a terminal carbon-carbon double bond and/or an internal
carbon-carbon double bond. A terminal alkenyl group is an alkenyl group wherein a
carbon-carbon double bond is located at a terminal position of a carbon chain. An
alkenyl group may also comprise two or more carbon-carbon double bonds. Examples of
an alkenyl group include ethenyl, propenyl, isopropenyl, t-butenyl, 1,3-butadienyl,
1,3-pentadienyl, etc. Unless stated otherwise, an alkenyl group may optionally be
substituted with one or more, independently selected, substituents as defined herein.
Unless stated otherwise, an alkenyl group optionally contains one or more heteroatoms
independently selected from the group consisting of O, NR
36, S, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized and the N atoms
are optionally quaternized.
[0049] An alkynyl group comprises one or more carbon-carbon triple bonds, and may be linear
or branched. Unsubstituted alkynyl groups comprising one C-C triple bond have the
general formula C
nH
2n-3. An alkynyl group may comprise a terminal carbon-carbon triple bond and/or an internal
carbon-carbon triple bond. A terminal alkynyl group is an alkynyl group wherein a
carbon-carbon triple bond is located at a terminal position of a carbon chain. An
alkynyl group may also comprise two or more carbon-carbon triple bonds. Unless stated
otherwise, an alkynyl group may optionally be substituted with one or more, independently
selected, substituents as defined herein. Examples of an alkynyl group include ethynyl,
propynyl, isopropynyl, t-butynyl, etc. Unless stated otherwise, an alkynyl group optionally
contains one or more heteroatoms independently selected from the group consisting
of O, NR
36, S, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized and the N atoms
are optionally quaternized.
[0050] An aryl group refers to an aromatic hydrocarbon ring system that comprises six to
twenty-four carbon atoms, more preferably six to twelve carbon atoms, and may include
monocyclic and polycyclic structures. When the aryl group is a polycyclic structure,
it is preferably a bicyclic structure. Optionally, the aryl group may be substituted
by one or more substituents further specified in this document. Examples of aryl groups
are phenyl and naphthyl.
[0051] Arylalkyl groups and alkylaryl groups comprise at least seven carbon atoms and may
include monocyclic and bicyclic structures. Optionally, the arylalkyl groups and alkylaryl
may be substituted by one or more substituents further specified in this document.
An arylalkyl group is for example benzyl. An alkylaryl group is for example 4-tert-butylphenyl.
[0052] Heteroaryl groups comprise at least two carbon atoms (i.e. at least C
2) and one or more heteroatoms N, O, P or S. A heteroaryl group may have a monocyclic
or a bicyclic structure. Optionally, the heteroaryl group may be substituted by one
or more substituents further specified in this document. Examples of suitable heteroaryl
groups include pyridinyl, quinolinyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrazinyl, pyrazolyl, imidazolyl,
thiazolyl, pyrrolyl, furanyl, triazolyl, benzofuranyl, indolyl, purinyl, benzoxazolyl,
thienyl, phospholyl and oxazolyl. Heteroaryl groups preferably comprise five to sixteen
carbon atoms and contain between one to five heteroatoms.
[0053] Heteroarylalkyl groups and alkylheteroaryl groups comprise at least three carbon
atoms (i.e. at least C
3) and may include monocyclic and bicyclic structures. Optionally, the heteroaryl groups
may be substituted by one or more substituents further specified in this document.
[0054] Where an aryl group is denoted as a (hetero)aryl group, the notation is meant to
include an aryl group and a heteroaryl group. Similarly, an alkyl(hetero)aryl group
is meant to include an alkylaryl group and an alkylheteroaryl group, and (hetero)arylalkyl
is meant to include an arylalkyl group and a heteroarylalkyl group. A C
2-C
24 (hetero)aryl group is thus to be interpreted as including a C
2-C
24 heteroaryl group and a C
6-C
24 aryl group. Similarly, a C
3-C
24 alkyl(hetero)aryl group is meant to include a C
7-C
24 alkylaryl group and a C
3-C
24 alkylheteroaryl group, and a C
3-C
24 (hetero)arylalkyl is meant to include a C
7-C
24 arylalkyl group and a C
3-C
24 heteroarylalkyl group.
[0055] A cycloalkenyl group is a cyclic alkenyl group. An unsubstituted cycloalkenyl group
comprising one double bond has the general formula C
nH
2n-3. Optionally, a cycloalkenyl group is substituted by one or more substituents further
specified in this document. An example of a cycloalkenyl group is cyclopentenyl. Unless
stated otherwise, a cycloalkenyl group optionally contains one or more heteroatoms
independently selected from the group consisting of O, NR
36, S, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized and the N atoms
are optionally quaternized.
[0056] A cycloalkynyl group is a cyclic alkynyl group. An unsubstituted cycloalkynyl group
comprising one triple bond has the general formula C
nH
2n-5. Optionally, a cycloalkynyl group is substituted by one or more substituents further
specified in this document. An example of a cycloalkynyl group is cyclooctynyl. Unless
stated otherwise, a cycloalkynyl group optionally contains one or more heteroatoms
independently selected from the group consisting of O, NR
36, S, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized and the N atoms
are optionally quaternized.
[0057] In general, when (hetero) is placed before a group, it refers to both the variant
of the group without the prefix hetero- as well as the group with the prefix hetero-.
Herein, the prefix hetero- denotes that the group contains one or more heteroatoms
selected from the group consisting of O, N, S, P, and Si. It will be understood that
groups with the prefix hetero- by definition contain heteroatoms. Hence, it will be
understood that if a group with the prefix hetero-is part of a list of groups that
is defined as optionally containing heteroatoms, that for the groups with the prefix
hetero- it is not optional to contain heteroatoms, but is the case by definition.
[0058] Herein, it will be understood that when the prefix hetero- is used for combinations
of groups, the prefix hetero- only refers to the one group before it is directly placed.
For example, heteroarylalkyl denotes the combination of a heteroaryl group and an
alkyl group, not the combination of a heteroaryl and a heteroalkyl group. As such,
it will be understood that when the prefix hetero- is used for a combination of groups
that is part of a list of groups that are indicated to optionally contain heteroatoms,
it is only optional for the group within the combination without the prefix hetero-
to contain a heteroatom, as it is not optional for the group within the combination
with the prefix hetero- by definition (see above). For example, if heteroarylalkyl
is part of a list of groups indicated to optionally contain heteroatoms, the heteroaryl
part is considered to contain heteroatoms by definition, while for the alkyl part
it is optional to contain heteroatoms.
[0059] Herein, the prefix cyclo- denotes that groups are cyclic. It will be understood that
when the prefix cyclo- is used for combinations of groups, the prefix cyclo- only
refers to the one group before it is directly placed. For example, cycloalkylalkenylene
denotes the combination of a cycloalkylene group (see the definition of the suffix
-ene below) and an alkenylene group, not the combination of a cycloalkylene and a
cycloalkenylene group.
[0060] In general, when (cyclo) is placed before a group, it refers to both the variant
of the group without the prefix cyclo- as well as the group with the prefix cyclo-.
[0061] Herein, the suffix -ene denotes divalent groups, i.e. that the group is linked to
at least two other moieties. An example of an alkylene is propylene (-CH
2-CH
2-CH
2-), which is linked to another moiety at both termini. It is understood that if a
group with the suffix -ene is substituted at one position with -H, then this group
is identical to a group without the suffix. For example, an alkylene substituted with
-H is identical to an alkyl group. I.e. propylene, -CH
2-CH
2-CH
2-, substituted with -H at one terminus, -CH
2-CH
2-CH
2-H, is logically identical to propyl, -CH
2-CH
2-CH
3.
[0062] Herein, when combinations of groups are listed with the suffix -ene, it refers to
a divalent group, i.e. that the group is linked to at least two other moieties, wherein
each group of the combination contains one linkage to one of these two moieties. As
such, for example alkylarylene is understood as a combination of an arylene group
and an alkylene group. An example of an alkylarylene group is -phenyl-CH
2-, and an example of an arylalkylene group is -CH
2-phenyl-.
[0063] Herein, the suffix -triyl denotes trivalent groups, i.e. that the group is linked
to at least three other moieties. An example of an arenetriyl is depicted below:

wherein the wiggly lines denote bonds to different groups of the main compound.
[0064] It is understood that if a group with the suffix -triyl is substituted at one position
with -H, then this group is identical to a divalent group with the suffix -ene. For
example, an arenetriyl substituted with -H is identical to an arylene group. Similarly,
it is understood that if a group with the suffix -triyl is substituted at two positions
with -H, then this group is identical to a monovalent group. For example, an arenetriyl
substituted with two -H is identical to an aryl group.
[0065] It is understood that if a group, for example an alkyl group, contains a heteroatom,
then this group is identical to a hetero-variant of this group. For example, if an
alkyl group contains a heteroatom, this group is identical to a heteroalkyl group.
Similarly, if an aryl group contains a heteroatom, this group is identical to a heteroaryl
group. It is understood that "contain" and its conjugations mean herein that when
a group contains a heteroatom, this heteroatom is part of the backbone of the group.
For example, a C
2 alkylene containing an N refers to -NH-CH
2-CH
2-, -CH
2-NH-CH
2-, and -CH
2-CH
2-NH-.
[0066] Unless indicated otherwise, a group may contain a heteroatom at non-terminal positions
or at one or more terminal positions. In this case, "terminal" refers to the terminal
position within the group, and not necessarily to the terminal position of the entire
compound. For example, if an ethylene group contains a nitrogen atom, this may refer
to -NH-CH
2-CH
2-, -CH
2-NH-CH
2-, and -CH
2-CH
2-NH-. For example, if an ethyl group contains a nitrogen atom, this may refer to -NH-CH
2-CH
3, -CH
2-NH-CH
3, and -CH
2-CH
2-NH
2.
[0067] Herein, it is understood that cyclic compounds (i.e. aryl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl,
etc.) are understood to be monocyclic, polycyclic or branched. It is understood that
the number of carbon atoms for cyclic compounds not only refers to the number of carbon
atoms in one ring, but that the carbon atoms may be comprised in multiple rings. These
rings may be fused to the main ring or substituted onto the main ring. For example,
C
10 aryl optionally containing heteroatoms may refer to
inter alia a naphthyl group (fused rings) or to
e.g. a bipyridyl group (substituted rings, both containing an N atom).
[0068] Unless stated otherwise, (hetero)alkyl groups, (hetero)alkenyl groups, (hetero)alkynyl
groups, (hetero)cycloalkyl groups, (hetero)cycloalkenyl groups, (hetero)cycloalkynyl
groups, (hetero)alkylcycloalkyl groups, (hetero)alkylcycloalkenyl groups, (hetero)alkylcycloalkynyl
groups, (hetero)cycloalkylalkyl groups, (hetero)cycloalkenylalkyl groups, (hetero)cycloalkynylalkyl
groups, (hetero)alkenylcycloalkyl groups, (hetero)alkenylcycloalkenyl groups, (hetero)alkenylcycloalkynyl
groups, (hetero)cycloalkylalkenyl groups, (hetero)cycloalkenylalkenyl groups, (hetero)cycloalkynylalkenyl
groups, (hetero)alkynylcycloalkyl groups, (hetero)alkynylcycloalkenyl groups, (hetero)alkynylcycloalkynyl
groups, (hetero)cycloalkylalkynyl groups, (hetero)cycloalkenylalkynyl groups, (hetero)cycloalkynylalkynyl
groups, (hetero)aryl groups, (hetero)arylalkyl groups, (hetero)arylalkenyl groups,
(hetero)arylalkynyl groups, alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups,
alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups, cycloalkenyl(hetero)aryl
groups, cycloalkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, (hetero)arylcycloalkenyl
groups, (hetero)arylcycloalkynyl groups, (hetero)alkylene groups, (hetero)alkenylene
groups, (hetero)alkynylene groups, (hetero)cycloalkylene groups, (hetero)cycloalkenylene
groups, (hetero)cycloalkynylene groups, (hetero)arylene groups, alkyl(hetero)arylene
groups, (hetero)arylalkylene groups, (hetero)arylalkenylene groups, (hetero)arylalkynylene
groups, alkenyl(hetero)arylene, alkynyl(hetero)arylene, (hetero)arenetriyl groups,
(hetero)cycloalkanetriyl groups, (hetero)cycloalkenetriyl and (hetero)cycloalkynetriyl
groups are optionally substituted with one or more substituents independently selected
from the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, - OH, -NH
2, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NR
36, -SR
36, C
1-C
24 alkyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
24 aryl groups, C
2-C
24 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
24 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkenyl groups, C
12-C
24 cycloalkynyl groups, C
3-C
24 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
24 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
24 (hetero)arylalkenyl groups, C
4-C
24 (hetero)arylalkynyl groups, C
4-C
24 alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
24 alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
24 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
6-C
24 alkylcycloalkenyl groups, C
13-C
24 alkylcycloalkynyl groups, C
4-C
24 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
6-C
24 cycloalkenylalkyl groups, C
13-C
24 cycloalkynylalkyl groups, C
5-C
24 alkenylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
24 alkenylcycloalkenyl groups, C
14-C
24 alkenylcycloalkynyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkylalkenyl groups, C
7-C
24 cycloalkenylalkenyl groups, C
14-C
24 cycloalkynylalkenyl groups, C
5-C
24 alkynylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
24 alkynylcycloalkenyl groups, C
14-C
24 alkynylcycloalkynyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkylalkynyl groups, C
7-C
24 cycloalkenylalkynyl groups, C
14-C
24 cycloalkynylalkynyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
7-C
24 cycloalkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
14-C
24 cycloalkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
5-C
24 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
24 (hetero)arylcycloalkenyl groups, and C
14-C
24 (hetero)arylcycloalkynyl groups. Unless stated otherwise, the substituents disclosed
herein optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of O, S, NR
36, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized. Preferably, these substituents optionally contain
one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of O, S, and NR
36.
[0069] In preferred embodiments, the substituents are selected from the group consisting
of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NR
36, -SR
36, C
1-C
12 alkyl groups, C
2-C
12 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
12 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
12 aryl groups, C
2-C
12 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
12 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkenyl groups, C
12 cycloalkynyl groups, C
3-C
12 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
12 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 (hetero)arylalkenyl groups, C
4-C
12 (hetero)arylalkynyl groups, C
4-C
12 alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
12 alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
12 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
6-C
12 alkylcycloalkenyl groups, C
13-C
16 alkylcycloalkynyl groups, C
4-C
12 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
6-C
12 cycloalkenylalkyl groups, C
13-C
16 cycloalkynylalkyl groups, C
5-C
12 alkenylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
12 alkenylcycloalkenyl groups, C
14-C
16 alkenylcycloalkynyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkylalkenyl groups, C
7-C
12 cycloalkenylalkenyl groups, C
14-C
16 cycloalkynylalkenyl groups, C
5-C
12 alkynylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
12 alkynylcycloalkenyl groups, C
14-C
16 alkynylcycloalkynyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkylalkynyl groups, C
7-C
12 cycloalkenylalkynyl groups, C
14-C
16 cycloalkynylalkynyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
7-C
12 cycloalkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
14-C
16 cycloalkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
5-C
12 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
12 (hetero)arylcycloalkenyl groups, and C
14-C
16 (hetero)arylcycloalkynyl groups.
[0070] In preferred embodiments, the substituents are selected from the group consisting
of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NR
36, -SR
36, C
1-C
7 alkyl groups, C
2-C
7 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
7 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
7 aryl groups, C
2-C
7 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
7 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
7 cycloalkenyl groups, C
12 cycloalkynyl groups, C
3-C
7 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
7 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
8 (hetero)arylalkenyl groups, C
4-C
8 (hetero)arylalkynyl groups, C
4-C
8 alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
8 alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
7 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
6-C
7 alkylcycloalkenyl groups, C
13-C
16 alkylcycloalkynyl groups, C
4-C
7 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
6-C
7 cycloalkenylalkyl groups, C
13-C
16 cycloalkynylalkyl groups, C
5-C
7 alkenylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
7 alkenylcycloalkenyl groups, C
14-C
16 alkenylcycloalkynyl groups, C
5-C
7 cycloalkylalkenyl groups, C
7-C
8 cycloalkenylalkenyl groups, C
14-C
16 cycloalkynylalkenyl groups, C
5-C
7 alkynylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
8 alkynylcycloalkenyl groups, C
14-C
16 alkynylcycloalkynyl groups, C
5-C
7 cycloalkylalkynyl groups, C
7-C
8 cycloalkenylalkynyl groups, C
14-C
16 cycloalkynylalkynyl groups, C
5-C
9 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
7-C
11 cycloalkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
14-C
16 cycloalkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
5-C
9 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
11 (hetero)arylcycloalkenyl groups, and C
14-C
16 (hetero)arylcycloalkynyl groups.
[0071] Unless stated otherwise, any group disclosed herein that is not cyclic is understood
to be linear or branched. In particular, (hetero)alkyl groups, (hetero)alkenyl groups,
(hetero)alkynyl groups, (hetero)alkylene groups, (hetero)alkenylene groups, (hetero)alkynylene
groups, and the like are linear or branched, unless stated otherwise.
[0072] The general term "sugar" is herein used to indicate a monosaccharide, for example
glucose (Glc), galactose (Gal), mannose (Man) and fucose (Fuc). The term "sugar derivative"
is herein used to indicate a derivative of a monosaccharide sugar, i.e. a monosaccharide
sugar comprising substituents and/or functional groups. Examples of a sugar derivative
include amino sugars and sugar acids, e.g. glucosamine (GlcNH
2), galactosamine (GalNH
2), N-acetylglucosamine (GlcNAc), N-acetylgalactosamine (GalNAc), sialic acid (Sia)
which is also referred to as N-acetylneuraminic acid (NeuNAc), and N-acetylmuramic
acid (MurNAc), glucuronic acid (GlcA) and iduronic acid (ldoA).
[0073] A sugar may be without further substitution, and then it is understood to be a monosaccharide.
A sugar may be further substituted with at one or more of its hydroxyl groups, and
then it is understood to be a disaccharide or an oligosaccharide. A disaccharide contains
two monosaccharide moieties linked together. An oligosaccharide chain may be linear
or branched, and may contain from 3 to 10 monosaccharide moieties.
[0074] The term "protein" is herein used in its normal scientific meaning. Herein, polypeptides
comprising about 10 or more amino acids are considered proteins. A protein may comprise
natural, but also unnatural amino acids. The term "protein" herein is understood to
comprise antibodies and antibody fragments.
[0075] The term "peptide" is herein used in its normal scientific meaning. Herein, peptides
are considered to comprise a number of amino acids in a range of from 2 to 9.
[0076] The term "peptoids" is herein used in its normal scientific meaning.
[0077] An antibody is a protein, typically generated by the immune system that is capable
of recognizing and binding to a specific antigen. While antibodies or immunoglobulins
derived from IgG antibodies are particularly well-suited for use in this invention,
immunoglobulins from any of the classes or subclasses may be selected, e.g. IgG, IgA,
IgM, IgD and IgE. Suitably, the immunoglobulin is of the class IgG including but not
limited to IgG subclasses (IgG1, 2, 3 and 4) or class IgM which is able to specifically
bind to a specific epitope on an antigen. Antibodies can be intact immunoglobulins
derived from natural sources or from recombinant sources and can be immunoreactive
portions of intact immunoglobulins. Antibodies may exist in a variety of forms including,
for example, polyclonal antibodies, monoclonal antibodies, camelized single domain
antibodies, recombinant antibodies, anti-idiotype antibodies, multispecific antibodies,
antibody fragments, such as, Fv, VHH, Fab, F(ab)
2, Fab', Fab'-SH, F(ab')
2, single chain variable fragment antibodies (scFv), tandem/bis-scFv, Fc, pFc', scFv-Fc,
disulfide Fv (dsFv), bispecific antibodies (bc-scFv) such as BiTE antibodies, trispecific
antibody derivatives such as tribodies, camelid antibodies, minibodies, nanobodies,
resurfaced antibodies, humanized antibodies, fully human antibodies, single domain
antibodies (sdAb, also known as Nanobody
™), chimeric antibodies, antibody fusions, chimeric antibodies comprising at least
one human constant region, dual-affinity antibodies such as dual-affinity retargeting
proteins (DART
™), and multimers and derivatives thereof, such as divalent or multivalent single-chain
variable fragments (e.g. di-scFvs, tri-scFvs) including but not limited to minibodies,
diabodies, triabodies, tribodies, tetrabodies, and the like, and multivalent antibodies.
Reference is made to [
Trends in Biotechnology 2015, 33, 2, 65], [
Trends Biotechnol. 2012, 30, 575-582], and [
Canc. Gen. Prot. 2013 10, 1-18], and [
BioDrugs 2014, 28, 331-343]. "Antibody fragment" refers to at least a portion of the variable region of the
immunoglobulin that binds to its target, i.e. the antigen-binding region. Other embodiments
use antibody mimetics, such as but not limited to Affimers, Anticalins, Avimers, Alphabodies,
Affibodies, DARPins, and multimers and derivatives thereof; reference is made to [
Trends in Biotechnology 2015, 33, 2, 65]. "Antibody" as used herein also refers to antibodies with further functionalities,
such as labelled antibodies, particularly radiolabeled antibodies, and antibody-drug
conjugates. For the avoidance of doubt, in the context of this invention the term
"antibody" is meant to encompass all of the antibody variations, fragments, derivatives,
fusions, analogs and mimetics outlined in this paragraph, unless specified otherwise.
[0078] A linker is herein defined as a moiety that connects two or more elements of a compound.
For example in a bioconjugate, a biomolecule and another moiety, e.g. a label, are
covalently connected to each other via a linker.
[0079] A biomolecule is herein defined as any molecule that can be isolated from nature
or any molecule composed of smaller molecular building blocks that are the constituents
of macromolecular structures derived from nature, in particular nucleic acids, proteins,
glycans and lipids. Examples of a biomolecule include an enzyme, a (non-catalytic)
protein, a polypeptide, a peptide, an amino acid, an oligonucleotide, a monosaccharide,
an oligosaccharide, a polysaccharide, a glycan, a lipid and a hormone.
[0080] As used herein, an organic molecule is defined as a molecule comprising a C-H bond.
Organic compound and organic molecule are used synonymously. It will be understood
that "organic molecule" as used herein includes biomolecules, such as nucleic acids
(oligonucleotides, polynucleotides, DNA, RNA), peptides, proteins (in particular antibodies),
carbohydrates (monosaccharides, oligosaccharides, and polysaccharides), aptamers,
hormones, toxins, steroids, cytokines, and lipids; small organic molecules as defined
herein; polymers (in particular polyethylene glycol); LNA and PNA; amino acids; peptoids;
molecules comprising a radionuclide; fluorescent dyes; drugs; resins (in particular
polystyrene and agarose); beads; particles (in particular polymersomes, liposomes,
and beads); gels; surfaces; organometallic compounds; cells; and combinations thereof.
[0081] As used herein, an inorganic molecule is defined as any molecule not being an organic
molecule,
i.e. not comprising a C-H bond. It will be understood that "inorganic molecule" as used
herein includes surfaces (in particular chips, wafers, gold, metal, silica-based surfaces
such as glass); particles such as beads (in particular magnetic beads, gold beads),
silica-based particles, polymer-based materials, iron oxide particles; caron nanotubes;
allotropes of carbon (in particular fullerenes such as Buckminsterfullerene; graphite,
graphene, diamond, Lonsdaleite, Q-carbon, linearn acetylenic carbon, amorphous carbon,
and carbon nanotubes); drugs (in particular cisplatin); and combinations thereof.
[0082] As used herein, "particle" is preferably defined as a microparticle or a nanoparticle.
[0083] The term "salt thereof' means a compound formed when an acidic proton, typically
a proton of an acid, is replaced by a cation, such as a metal cation or an organic
cation and the like. The term "salt thereof' also means a compound formed when an
amine is protonated. Where applicable, the salt is a pharmaceutically acceptable salt,
although this is not required for salts that are not intended for administration to
a patient. For example, in a salt of a compound the compound may be protonated by
an inorganic or organic acid to form a cation, with the conjugate base of the inorganic
or organic acid as the anionic component of the salt.
[0084] The term "pharmaceutically accepted" salt means a salt that is acceptable for administration
to a patient, such as a mammal (salts with counterions having acceptable mammalian
safety for a given dosage regime). Such salts may be derived from pharmaceutically
acceptable inorganic or organic bases and from pharmaceutically acceptable inorganic
or organic acids.
[0085] "Pharmaceutically acceptable salt" refers to pharmaceutically acceptable salts of
a compound, which salts are derived from a variety of organic and inorganic counter
ions known in the art and include, for example, sodium, potassium, calcium, magnesium,
ammonium, tetraalkylammonium, etc., and when the molecule contains a basic functionality,
salts of organic or inorganic acids, such as hydrochloride, hydrobromide, formate,
tartrate, besylate, mesylate, acetate, maleate, oxalate, etc.
[0086] In preferred embodiments, in relation to the invention "particle" is defined as a
nanoparticle or a microparticle.
[0087] The logarithm of the partition-coefficient, i.e. Log P, is herein used as a measure
of the hydrophobicity of a compound. Typically, the Log P is defined as

The skilled person is aware of methods to determine the partition-coefficient of compounds
without undue experimentation. Alternatively, the skilled person knows that software
is available to reliably estimate the Log P value, for example as a function within
ChemDraw
® software or online available tools.
[0088] The unified atomic mass unit or Dalton is herein abbreviated to Da. The skilled person
is aware that Dalton is a regular unit for molecular weight and that 1 Da is equivalent
to 1 g/mol (grams per mole).
[0089] It will be understood that herein, the terms "moiety" and "group" are used interchangeably
when referring to a part of a molecule.
[0090] It will be understood that when a heteroatom is denoted as -X(R')
2-, wherein X is the heteroatom and R' is a certain moiety, then this denotes that
two moieties R' are attached to the heteroatom.
[0091] It will be understood that when a group is denoted as, for example, -((R
51)
2-R
52)
2- or a similar notation, in which R
51 and R
52 are certain moieties, then this denotes that first, it should be written as -R
51-R
51-R
52-R
51-R
51-R
52-before the individual R
51 and R
52 moieties are selected, rather than first selecting moieties R
51 and R
52 and then writing out the formula.
The Inverse Electron-Demand Diels-Alder reaction (IEDDA)
[0092] The established IEDDA conjugation chemistry generally involves a pair of reactants
that comprise, as one reactant (i.e. one Bio-orthogonal Reactive Group), a suitable
diene, such as a derivative of tetrazine (TZ), e.g. an electron-deficient tetrazine
and, as the other reactant (i.e. the other Bio-orthogonal Reactive Group), a suitable
dienophile, such as a
trans-cyclooctene (TCO). The exceptionally fast reaction of (substituted) tetrazines, in
particular electron-deficient tetrazines, with a TCO moiety results in an intermediate
that rearranges to a dihydropyridazine Diels-Alder adduct by eliminating N
2 as the sole by-product. The initially formed 4,5-dihydropyridazine product may tautomerize
to a 1,4- or a 2,5-dihydropyridazine product, especially in aqueous environments.
Below a reaction scheme is given for a [4+2] IEDDA reaction between (3,6)-di-(2-pyridyl)-s-tetrazine
diene and a
trans-cyclooctene dienophile, followed by a retro Diels Alder reaction in which the product
and dinitrogen is formed. Because the
trans-cyclooctene derivative does not contain electron withdrawing groups as in the classical
Diels Alder reaction, this type of Diels Alder reaction is distinguished from the
classical one, and frequently referred to as an "inverse-electron-demand Diels Alder
(IEDDA) reaction". In the following text the sequence of both reaction steps, i.e.
the initial Diels-Alder cyclo-addition (typically an inverse electron-demand Diels
Alder cyclo-addition) and the subsequent retro Diels Alder reaction will be referred
to in shorthand as the "inverse electron-demand Diels Alder reaction" or "inverse
electron-demand Diels Alder conjugation" or "IEDDA". The product of the reaction is
then the IEDDA adduct or conjugate. This is illustrated in Scheme 1 below.

Scheme 1: the IEDDA conjugation reaction
[0093] The two reactive species are abiotic and do not undergo fast metabolism or side reactions
in vitro or in vivo. They are bio-orthogonal, e.g. they selectively react with each
other in physiologic media. Thus, the compounds and the method of the invention can
be used in a living organism. Moreover, the reactive groups are relatively small and
can be introduced in biological samples or living organisms without significantly
altering the size of biomolecules therein. References on the inverse electron demand
Diels Alder reaction, and the behavior of the pair of reactive species include: [
Thalhammer et al., Tetrahedron Lett., 1990, 31, 47, 6851-6854], [
Wijnen et al., J. Org. Chem., 1996, 61, 2001-2005], [
Blackman et al., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2008, 130, 41, 13518-19], [
Rossin et al., Angew. Chem. Int. Ed. 2010, 49, 3375], [
Devaraj et al., Angew. Chem. Int. Ed. 2009, 48, 7013], [
Devaraj et al., Angew. Chem. Int. Ed., 2009, 48, 1-5].
The IEDDA Pyridazine Elimination Reaction
[0094] Below, the dienophile, a TCO, that may be comprised in kits of the invention may
be referred to as a "Trigger" (T
R). The dienophile is connected at the allylic position to a Construct-A. Moreover,
tetrazines that are used in the IEDDA pyridazine elimination reaction may be referred
to as "Cleaving Agents". For ease of reference, the term Construct-A in this invention
is used to indicate an Administration Agent or a Label, of which it is desired to
have it first in a bound state, and being able to provoke release from that state.
[0095] Without wishing to be bound by theory, the inventors believe that the Cleaving Agent
provokes Construct-A release via a cascade mechanism within the IEDDA adduct, i.e.
the dihydropyridazine. The cascade mechanism can be a simple one step reaction, or
it can be comprised in multiple steps that involves one or more intermediate structures.
These intermediates may be stable for some time or may immediately degrade to the
thermodynamic end-product or to the next intermediate structure. In any case, whether
it be a simple or a multistep process, the result of the cascade mechanism is that
the Construct-A gets released from the IEDDA adduct. Without wishing to be bound by
theory, the design of the diene is such that the distribution of electrons within
the IEDDA adduct is unfavorable, so that a rearrangement of these electrons must occur.
This situation initiates the cascade mechanism, and it therefore induces the release
of the Construct-A. Specifically, and without wishing to be bound by theory, the inventors
believe that the NH moiety comprised in the various dihydropyridazine tautomers, such
as the 1,4-dihydropyridazine tautomer, of the IEDDA adduct can initiate an electron
cascade reaction, a concerted or consecutive shift of electrons over several bonds,
leading to release of the Construct-A. Occurrence of the cascade reaction in and /or
Construct-A release from the Trigger is not efficient or cannot take place prior to
the IEDDA reaction, as the Trigger-Construct-A conjugate itself is relatively stable
as such. The cascade can only take place after the Cleaving Agent and the Trigger-Construct
conjugate have reacted and have been assembled in the IEDDA adduct.
[0096] With reference to Scheme 2 below, and without wishing to be bound by theory, the
inventors believe that the pyridazine elimination occurs from the 1,4-dihydropyridazine
tautomer 4. Upon formation of the 4,5-dihydropyridazine
3, tautomerization affords intermediates
4 and
7, of which the 2,5-dihydropyridazine
7 cannot eliminate the Construct-A (C
A). Instead it can slowly convert into aromatic
8, which also cannot eliminate C
A or it can tautomerize back to intermediate
3. Upon formation of
4 the C
A is eliminated near instantaenously, affording free C
A 8 as an amine, and pyridazine elimination products
5 and
6. This elimination reaction has been shown to work equally well in the cleavage of
carbamates, carbonates, esters and ethers from the TCO trigger [
Versteegen et al., Angew. Chem. Int. Ed., 2018, 57, 10494]. The Trigger in Scheme 2 is also optionally bound to a Construct-B (C
B) , which in this case cannot release from the Trigger. Thereby Construct A can be
seperated from Construct B by means of the IEDDA pyridazine elimination.

Scheme 2. IEDDA pyridazine elimination mechanism.
[0097] In preferred embodiments, the dienophile trigger moiety used in the present invention
comprises a
trans-cyclooctene ring. Herein, this eight-membered ring moiety will be defined as a
trans-cyclooctene moiety, for the sake of legibility, or abbreviated as "TCO" moiety. It
will be understood that the essence resides in the possibility of the eight-membered
ring to act as a dienophile and to be released from its conjugated Construct-A upon
reaction.
[0098] The tetrazines of the kits of the invention and dienophiles are capable of reacting
in an inverse electron-demand Diels-Alder reaction (IEDDA). IEDDA reaction of the
Trigger with the Cleaving Agent leads to release of the Construct-A through an electron-cascade-based
elimination, termed the "pyridazine elimination". When a Cleaving Agent reacts with
a Trigger capable of eliminating Construct-A, the combined proces of reaction and
Construct-A elimination is termed the "IEDDA pyridazine elimination".
[0099] This invention provides a Cleaving Agent that reacts with a Construct-A-conjugated
Trigger, resulting in the cleavage of the Trigger from the Construct-A. In one prominent
embodiment this results in the cleavage of Construct-A from Construct-B. In another
embodiment the Trigger cleavage results in cleavage of one Construct A from another
Construct A, as the dienophile Trigger of Formula (1) can comprise two allylic positioned
Constructs-A, wherein one or both can release from the Trigger upon reaction with
a diene. In another embodiment, Trigger cleavage results in the cleavage of one or
more Construct-A from one or more Construct-B. Construct-B is the Construct,
i.e. either Administration Agent or Label depending on the nature of Construct-A, that
is bound to the dienophile, and cannot be released from the dienophile, unless it
is bound to the allylic position via a spacer or self-imolative linker that also binds
Construct-A . In preferred embodiments, the Trigger is used as a reversible covalent
bond between two molecular species.
[0100] Scheme 3a below is a general scheme of Construct release according to a preferred
embodiment of this invention, wherein the Construct being released is termed Construct-A
(C
A), and wherein another Construct, Construct-B (C
B) is bound to the dienophile but not via the allylic position, wherein Construct-B
cannot be released from the dienophile, and wherein either Construct A or B is the
Administration Agent and the other is the Label.

Scheme 3a: General scheme of IEDDA pyridazine elimination reaction for the release
of Construct-A from Construct-B according to a preferred embodiment of this invention
[0101] Scheme 3b below is a general scheme of Construct release according to another embodiment
of this invention, wherein Construct-B (C
B) is bound to the dienophile via a spacer or self-imolative linker that also binds
Construct-A and, wherein when the spacer or self-immolative linker is released from
the allylic position then Construct-B and Construct A are released from the Trigger
and from each other.

Scheme 3b: General scheme of IEDDA pyridazine elimination reaction for the release
of Construct-A from Construct-B according to a another embodiment of this invention
[0102] Scheme 3c below is a general scheme of Construct release according to another embodiment
of this invention, wherein the Trigger is linked to two allylic positioned Construct-A's,
and wherein one or both Constructs-A's can be released from the Trigger, in any case
resulting in cleavage of one Construct-A from the other Construct-A, and and wherein
one Construct-A is the Administration Agent and the other Construct-A is the Label.

Scheme 3c: General scheme of IEDDA pyridazine elimination reaction for the release
of Construct-A from another Construct-A according to a preferred embodiment of this
invention
[0103] The Construct release occurs through a powerful, abiotic, bio-orthogonal reaction
of the dienenophile (Trigger) with the diene (Cleaving Agent), viz. the aforementioned
IEDDA. The bound Construct is a Construct-dienenophile conjugate. Possibly the Construct-A
is linked to one or more additional Constructs A linked via a spacer, for example
a self-immolative linker. It will be understood that in Scheme 3a, 3b and 3c in the
IEDDA adduct as well as in the end product after release, the indicated dienophile
group and the indicated diene group are the residues of, respectively, the dienophile
and diene groups after these groups have been converted in the IEDDA reaction.
[0104] The difference between C
A and C
B is that the bond between C
B and the moiety holding C
B is not broken upon reaction of the Trigger with the diene, whereas the bond between
C
A and the moiety holding C
A is broken upon reaction of the Trigger with the diene. A person skilled in the art
will understand that the moiety holding C
A and C
B refers to the Trigger, or a self immolative linker L
C bound to the Trigger. For the sake of clarity, when C
B is bound to a L
C that is bound to the Trigger, the L
C holding C
B will release from the Trigger upon reaction with the diene but the C
B will not release from the released L
C. Likewise if C
B is bound directly to the Trigger, C
B will not release from the Trigger upon. reaction with the diene. A person skilled
in the art will understand that when it is required to seperate one Label from one
Administration Agent, that preferably one of the following requirements is met:
- 1) one CA comprises the Label and another CA comprises the Adminstration Agent
- 2) either Label or Adminstration Agent is CA and the other is CB
- 3) Label and Adminstration Agent are both CB, provided that one CB is not part of R48 and the other is bound to a LC which is part of R48, or provided that one CB moiety is bound to a different LC moiety than the other CB moiety.
[0105] Other than is the case with e.g. medicinally active substances, where the
in vitro or
in vivo action is often changed with minor structural changes, the present invention first
and foremost requires the right chemical reactivity combined with sufficient stability
for the intended application. Thus, the possible structures extend to those of which
the skilled person is familiar with that these are reactive as dienes or dienophiles.
Targeting
[0106] A "primary target" as used in the present invention, both in relation to the Administration
Agent and the Cleaving Agent, relates to a target to be detected in a diagnostic and/or
imaging method, and/or to be modulated, bound, or otherwise addressed by a pharmaceutically
active compound, or other therapeutic modality. The primary target can be selected
from any suitable target within the human or animal body or on a pathogen or parasite.
For example, a primary target can be any molecule or tissue, which is present in an
organism, tissue or cell. Targets include cells components such as cell membranes
and cell walls, cell surface targets, e.g. receptors, glycoproteins; structural proteins,
e.g. amyloid plaques; extracellular targets such as stroma targets, tumor microenvironment
targets, extracellular matrix targets such as growth factors, and proteases; intracellular
targets, e.g. surfaces of Golgi bodies, surfaces of mitochondria, RNA, DNA, enzymes,
components of cell signaling pathways; and/or foreign bodies, e.g. pathogens such
as viruses, viral particles, bacteria, fungi, yeast or parts thereof. Examples of
primary targets include compounds such as proteins of which the presence or expression
level is correlated with a certain tissue or cell type or of which the expression
level is up regulated or down-regulated in a certain disorder. According to a particular
embodiment of the present invention, the primary target is a protein such as a (internalizing
or non-internalizing) receptor. According to a preferred embodiment of the present
invention, the primary target is an internalizing receptor. According to another preferred
embodiment of the present invention, the primary target is a non-internalizing receptor.
[0107] In preferred embodiments the Primary Target can be a system in the body, such as
blood circulation, lymphatic system, the nervous system, the digestion system, RES
system, or organs such as the heart or kidney. For example, there are imaging agents
that visualize blood flow, the liver, or identify the sentinel lymph node of a tumor.
[0108] Alternatively, the primary target may be a metabolic pathway, which is upregulated
during a disease, e.g. infection or cancer, such as DNA synthesis, protein synthesis,
membrane synthesis and carbohydrate uptake. In diseased tissues, above-mentioned markers
can differ from healthy tissue and offer unique possibilities for early detection,
specific diagnosis and therapy, especially targeted therapy.
[0109] Other non-limiting examples of Primary Targets include antibodies, proteins, carbohydrates,
monosacharides, polysaccharides, cytokines, hormones, steroids, somatostatin receptor,
monoamine oxidase, muscarinic receptors, myocardial sympatic nerve system, leukotriene
receptors, e.g. on leukocytes, urokinase plasminogen activator receptor (uPAR), folate
receptor, apoptosis marker, (anti-angiogenesis marker, gastrin receptor, dopaminergic
system, serotonergic system, GABAergic system, adrenergic system, cholinergic system,
opoid receptors, GPIIb/IIIa receptor and other thrombus related receptors, fibrin,
calcitonin receptor, tuftsin receptor, integrin receptor, fibronectin, VEGF/EGF and
VEGF/EGF receptors, TAG72, CEA, CD19, CD20,CD22, CD40, CD45, CD74, CD79, CD105, CD138,
CD174, CD227, CD326, CD340, MUC1, MUC16, GPNMB, PSMA, Cripto, Tenascin C, Melanocortin-1
receptor, CD44v6, G250, HLA DR, ED-A, ED-B, TMEFF2 , EphB2, EphA2, FAP, Mesothelin,
GD2, CAIX, 5T4, matrix metalloproteinase (MMP), P/E/L-selectin receptor, LDL receptor,
P-glycoprotein, neurotensin receptors, neuropeptide receptors, substance P receptors,
NK receptor, CCK receptors, sigma receptors, interleukin receptors, herpes simplex
virus tyrosine kinase, human tyrosine kinase, MSR1, FAP, CXCR, tumor endothelial marker
(TEM), cMET, IGFR, FGFR, GPA33, hCG, According to a further particular embodiment
of the invention, the primary target and targeting agent are selected so as to result
in the specific or increased targeting of a tissue or disease, such as cancer, an
inflammation, an infection, a cardiovascular disease, e.g. thrombus, atherosclerotic
lesion, hypoxic site, e.g. stroke, tumor, cardiovascular disorder, brain disorder,
apoptosis, angiogenesis, an organ, and reporter gene/enzyme. This can be achieved
by selecting primary targets with tissue-, cell- or disease- specific expression.
For example, membrane folic acid receptors mediate intracellular accumulation of folate
and its analogs, such as methotrexate. Expression is limited in normal tissues, but
receptors are overexpressed in various tumor cell types.
[0110] In preferred embodiments the Primary Target equals a therapeutic target.
[0111] Preferred internalizing targets are:
Transferrin receptor, urokinase plasminogen activator receptor (uPAR), folate receptor,
gastrin receptor, GPIIb/IIIa receptor, calcitonin receptor, tuftsin receptor, integrin
receptor, VEGF/EGF receptors, CD19, CD20, CD22, CD25, CD30, CD33, CD40, CD45, CD56,
CD70, CD74, CD79, CD105, CD123, CD138, CD163, CD174, CD184, CD227, CD269, CD326, CD340,
CD352, MUC1, MUC16, GPNMB, PSMA, Cripto, Melanocortin-1 receptor, HLA DR, TMEFF2 ,
EphB2, EphA2, FAP, Mesothelin, GD2, CAIX, 5T4, matrix metalloproteinases (MMP), ADAM-9,
P/E/L-selectin receptor, LDL receptor, P-glycoprotein, neurotensin receptors, neuropeptide
receptors, substance P receptors, NK receptor, CCK receptors, CXCR, tumor endothelial
marker (TEM), cMET, IGFR, FGFR, GPA33, hCG, platelet-derived growth factor (PDGF),
HER2, HER3, CA19, TAM, LGALS3BP, nectin-4, IFGR, cMET, PD1, PDL1, GPNMB, AGS-5, AGS-16,
endosialin, ETBR, TM4SF1, BCMA, GPC2, TROP-2, AXL, HLA-DR, B7-H3, MTX3, MTX5, EFNA4,
NOTCH, tissue factor (TF), PDGFR, GITR, OX40, RIG, MDA-5, NLRP1, NLRP3, AIM2, IDO,
MEK, cGAS, NKG2A.
[0112] Preferred non-internalizing targets are Fibronectin ED-A, Fibronectin ED-B, VEGF,
EGF , TAG72, CEA, CD20, CD25, MUC1, MUC16, Tenascin C, CD44v6, CAIX, matrix metalloproteinase
(e.g. MMP2), A33, mesothelin, LGALS3BP, hCG, nectin-4, CD45, G250, GPA33 , GD2, PD1,
PDL1, GITR, CD3, CD28, CTLA4, OX40, RIG, MDA-5, NLRP1, NLRP3, AIM2, IDO, MEK, cGAS,
NKG2A.
[0113] The person skilled in the art will understand that the preceding classification is
relative, as most targets are not completely internalizing or non-internalizing, but
instead can be classified as relatively internalizing or relatively non-internalizing,
as compared to other targets, such as TAG72 (non-internalizing) and HER2 (fast internalizing).
The person skilled in the art will understand that internalization rate is an important
factor in this classification, and that the nature of the Administration Agent or
Targeting Agent T
T can affect this rate.
Compounds of Formula (1)
[0114] The invention pertains to compounds of Formula (1) as disclosed herein. It will be
understood that the compounds of Formula (1) comprise an eight-membered trans-ring,
preferably a trans-cyclooctene, formed by -CHR
48, -C=C-, and X
1-X
5.

[0115] R
48 is selected from the group consisting of -L
B, and -L
A.
[0116] In a preferred embodiment, R
48 is -L
L.
[0117] In a preferred embodiment, R
48 is -L
A.
[0118] As is clear from the definitions of -L
B and -L
A herein, both -L
B and -L
A may comprise a moiety L
C, which is an optional self-immolative linker, which may consist of multiple units
arranged linearly and/or branched and may release one or more moieties that are denoted
as C
A moieties, while moieties that are not released from the L
C may be denoted as C
B. It will be understood that if L
C comprises more than one C
A moiety, these C
A moieties can independently be Label or Administration Agent, optionally linked to
L
C via a spacer S
P, since both are released due to the self-immolative character of L
C. Preferably, if L
C comprises one C
B, then said C
B moiety may be either Administration Agent or Label. Preferably, if L
C comprises more than one C
B, then said C
B moieties are all either Administration Agent or Label. It will be understood that
in such a way, one R
48 group may comprise both a Label and an Administration Agent, that are uncoupled after
reaction of the compound of Formula (1) with a Cleaving Agent due to the self-immolative
character of the linker L
C.
[0119] By way of further clarification, if R
48 is L
B and all d and e in Formula (2) are 0, the Label directly constitutes the leaving
group of the release reaction, and if one of d or e in Formula (2) is 1, S
L, which may be a self-immolative linker L
C, constitutes the leaving group of the release reaction.
[0120] In Formula (1), R
48 is bound to the remainder of the compound of Formula (1) via a part of R
48 that is -O-, -S-, -OC(O)-, -OC(S)-, -SC(O)-, or -SC(S)-; preferably -O-, or -OC(O)-,
most preferably -OC(O)N- (
i.e. a carbamate). Preferably, the -O- or -S- is directly coupled to an aromatic moiety
that is also part of R
48. Preferably, the -OC(O)-, -OC(S)-, -SC(O)-, or -SC(S)- are directly coupled to a
carbon, oxygen, nitrogen, or sulphur atom that is also part of R
48, preferably to a secondary or tertiary amine. In a preferred embodiment, in Formula
(1), R
48 is bound to the remainder of the compound of Formula (1) via a part of R
48 that is -O-R
97-, -S-R
97-, -OC(O)-R
97-, -OC(S)-R
97-, -SC(O)-R
97-, or -SC(S)-R
97-. In a preferred embodiment, in Formula (1), R
48 is bound to the remainder of the compound of Formula (1) via a part of R
48 that is -O-, -S-R
99-, - OC(O)-, -OC(O)-R
99-, -OC(S)-R
99-, -SC(O)-R
99-, or -SC(S)-R
99-.
[0121] It will be understood, that preferably this notation indicates that in e.g. -OC(O)-R
99-, the first O is attached to the eight-membered ring of Formula (1), and R
99 is connected to the remainder of R
48. It will be understood that -O- denotes an ether, and can be an aromatic ether or
an aliphatic ether. Likewise, -OC(O)-denotes an ester, that can be an aromatic ester
or an aliphatic ester, preferably an aromatic ester. It will be understood that the
part of R
48 that is -O-, -OC(O)-, or -OC(S)-, could be part of a spacer S
P or S
L, if present, or of the Administration Agent or the Label, if no spacer S
P or S
L is present.
[0122] In Formula (1), when R
48 is L
B and does not comprise an Administration Agent, then R
48 being L
B preferably has a molecular weight of at most 50 kDa, and preferably of at most 5
kDa, even more preferably at most 2 kDa, even more preferably at most 1 kDa, even
more preferably at most 500 Da.
[0123] In Formula (1), when R
48 is L
A and does not comprise a Label then the compound of Formula (1) without R
48 preferably has a molecular weight of at most 50 kDa, and more preferably of at most
5 kDa, even more preferably at most 2 kDa, even more preferably at most 1 kDa. Preferably,
when Formula (1) comprises one R
48 moiety that is L
A and does not comprise a Label, then the compound of Formula (1) without R
48 being L
A has a molecular weight of at most 50 kDa, and more preferably of at most 5 kDa, even
more preferably at most 2 kDa, even more preferably at most 1 kDa. Preferably, when
Formula (1) comprises two R
48 moieties that are L
A and do not comprise a Label, then the compound of Formula (1) without both R
48 has a molecular weight of at most 50 kDa, and more preferably of at most 5 kDa, even
more preferably at most 2 kDa, even more preferably at most 1 kDa.
[0124] The compound of Formula (1) comprises at least one Label and at least one Administration
Agent. Preferably, the compound of Formula (1) comprises at most one Label and at
most one Administration Agent.
[0125] Preferably, when at least one R
48 is L
B, then X
1, X
2, X
3, and X
4 do not comprise the same Label as comprised in R
48 being L
B. Preferably, when at least one R
48 is L
A, then X
1, X
2, X
3, and X
4 do not comprise an L
A.
[0126] In particularly favorable embodiments, one or both R
48 is/are in the axial position.
[0127] Preferably, if X
5 is -C(R
47)
2-, R
48 comprises a Label, and R
48 does not comprise an Administration Agent, then X
1-X
5 do not comprise the same Label as comprised in R
48.
[0128] Preferably, if X
5 is -C(R
47)
2-, R
48 comprises an Administration Agent, and R
48 does not comprise a Label, then X
1-X
5 do not comprise the same Administration Agent as comprised in R
48.
[0129] Preferably, if X
5 is -C(R
47)
2-, and R
48 comprises at least one Administration Agent and at least one Label, then X
1-X
5 optionally comprise either the same Administration Agent as comprised in R
48 or the same Label as comprised in R
48.
[0130] In Formula (1), L
A only comprises both the Label and the Administration Agent when L
A is R
48.
[0131] In Formula (1), if L
A being R
48 comprises both the Label and the Administration Agent, then the S
P linked to said Label and said Administration Agent is a self-immolative linker, preferably
with the proviso that at least one of Label and Administration Agent is C
Ain the definition of L
C or the proviso that the Label and Administration Agent are bound to different L
C moieties within the same R
48.
Formula (2)
[0132] In Formula (1), the moiety L
B satisfies Formula (2):

[0133] Formula (2); wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to the remainder of the compound
of Formula (1).
[0134] In Formula (2) each d independently is 0 or 1. In a preferred embodiment, at least
one d is 1. In another preferred embodiment, both d are 1. In yet another preferred
embodiment, both d are 0.
[0135] In Formula (2) e is an integer in a range of from 0 to 4, preferably e is at most
3, more preferably at most 2, most preferably e is at most 1. In a preferred embodiment,
e is 1. In another preferred embodiment, e is 0.
[0136] In Formula (2), the Label is preferably as defined herein. -L
B does not comprise an Administration Agent.
[0137] Preferably, Formula (2) is -S
L-Label, wherein S
L is a polyethyleneglycol (PEG), more preferably S
L is PEG
4.
Linker SL
[0138] In Formula (2), S
L is a linker, which may be a self-immolative linker L
C as defined herein.
[0139] Preferably, S
L is defined as S
P as defined herein, wherein it will be understood that when S
L is attached to an R
98, in some embodiments S
L is a trivalent radical, and the suffix -ene in a preferred definition of S
P is replaced with -triyl.
[0140] In preferred embodiments, S
L being S
P comprises at least one moiety selected from the group consisting of a residue of
R
32, a moiety C
M2, and a moiety C
X; all as described herein. In preferred embodiments, said C
M2, C
X or a residue of R
32 connects the S
P to a Label, L
C, S
P, R
98, or T
R.
[0141] In a preferred embodiment, S
L is L
C. Preferably, when S
L is L
C, then e is 0, one d is 0, and one d is 1. In another preferred embodiment, S
L is not L
C when S
L is comprised in any one of X
1-X
4. In another preferred embodiment, S
L is not L
C.
R98
[0142] In Formula (2), each R
98 individually is a Label or a clearance-directing group. In a preferred embodiment,
R
98 is a Label. The Label of R
98 is preferably as defined herein, and may be the same Label as the one comprised in
L
B that is not R
98, or a different Label.
R99
[0143] R
99 is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -C(R
36)
2-, -S-, and -NR
36-.
Clearance-directing group
[0144] A clearance-directing group is a moiety that directs a compound to an excretory organ,
such as the kidneys or the liver. In that way, it ensures faster clearance of a compound
from the blood in a subject and / or it controls which excretory organ will or will
not process the compound to improve imaging procedures or non-target tissue dosimetry.
In relation to the invention, it will be understood that the increased clearance rate
of the Label after being separated from the Administration Agent is mainly due to
this separation, and that the clearance-directing group merely further enhances the
clearance rate of the Label and / or controls the clearance pathway.
[0145] In a preferred embodiment, the clearance-directing group is hexose-based. Hexose-based
clearance-directing groups incorporate one or more hexoses (six carbon sugar moieties)
recognized by Ashwell receptors or other receptors such as the mannose/N-acetylglucosamine
receptor which are associated with hepatocytes, endothelial cells and/or Kupffer cells
of the liver or the mannose 6-phosphate receptor.
[0146] Exemplary hexoses are galactose, mannose, mannose 6-phosphate, N-acetylglucosamine,
pentamannosylphosphate, and the like. Other moieties recognized by Ash well receptors,
including glucose, N-galactosamine, N-acetylgalactosamine, pentamannosyl phosphate,
thioglycosides of galactose and, generally, D-galactosides and glucosides or the like
may also be used in the practice of the present invention.
[0147] In a preferred embodiment, the clearance-directing group is galactose.
Formula (3)
[0149] In Formula (1), L
A is a moiety satisfying Formula (3):

wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to the remainder of the compound of Formula
(1).
[0150] In Formula (3) each s independently is 0 or 1. In a preferred embodiment, at least
one s is 1. In another preferred embodiment, both s are 1. In yet another preferred
embodiment, both s are 0.
[0151] In Formula (3) i is an integer in a range of from 0 to 4, preferably i is at most
3, more preferably at most 2, most preferably i is at most 1. In a preferred embodiment,
i is 1. In another preferred embodiment, i is 0.
[0152] In Formula (3), A
A denotes an Administration Agent that is an antibody.
[0153] In a preferred embodiment, Formula (3) is -S
P-A
A, wherein S
P is a polyethylene glycol (PEG), more preferably S
P is PEG
8.
[0154] In a preferred embodiment, moiety L
A has a molecular weight of at most 500 kDa, more preferably at most 200 kDa, most
preferably at most 160 kDa.
[0155] In a preferred embodiment, moiety L
A has a molecular weight of at least 0.1 kDa, more preferably at least 1 kDa, more
preferably at least 10 kDa, most preferably at least 140 kDa.
[0156] In Formula (3), each S
P independently is a spacer, which optionally is a self-immolative linker L
C as defined herein. It will be understood that if S
P is linked to C
C, then S
P is preferably a trivalent radical and the suffix -ene in the definition of S
L is to be replaced with the suffix -triyl. Preferably, S
P is a spacer as defined herein. Preferably, when S
P is L
C, then i in Formula (3) is 0, one s is 0, and one s is 1.
[0157] In Formula (3) C
C denotes a Construct-C, wherein each Construct-C is independently selected from the
group consisting of a Label, and an additional Administration Agent. The additional
Administration Agent may be the same Administration Agent as comprised in L
A not being C
C, or it may be a different Administration Agent.
[0158] In a preferred embodiment, the compound of Formula (1) comprises at most one C
C. Preferably, when i in Formula (3) is at least 1, then in -S
P-C
C, the S
P is an L
C.
[0159] In preferred embodiments, S
P in Formula (3) comprises at least one moiety selected from the group consisting of
a residue of R
32, a moiety C
M2, and a moiety C
X; all as described herein. In preferred embodiments, said C
M2, C
X or a residue of R
32 connects the S
P to a Label, an Administration Agent, L
C, S
P, C
C, or T
R. In a preferred embodiment, L
A does not comprise a Label. In a preferred embodiment, X
5 does not comprise C
C, L
A, or L
B.
Spacers SP
[0160] It will be understood that when herein, it is stated that "each individual S
P is linked at all ends to the remainder of the structure" this refers to the fact
that the spacer S
P connects multiple moieties within a structure, and therefore the spacer has multiple
ends by defintion. The spacer S
P may be linked to each individual moiety via different or identical moieties that
may be each individually selected. Typically, these linking moieties are to be seen
to be part of spacer S
P itself. In case the spacer S
P links two moieties within a structure, "all ends" should be interpreted as "both
ends". As an example, if the spacer connects a trans-cyclooctene moiety to a Construct
A, then "the remainder of the molecule" refers to the trans-cylooctene moiety and
Construct A, while the connecting moieties between the spacer and the trans-cyclooctene
moiety and Construct A (i.e. at both ends) may be individually selected.
[0161] Spacers S
P may consist of one or multiple Spacer Units S
U arranged linearly and/or branched and may be connected to one or more C
A or C
B moieties and / or one or more L
C or T
R moieties. The Spacer may be used to connect C
B to one T
R (Example A) or more T
R (Example B and C), but it can also be used to modulate the properties, e.g. pharmacokinetic
properties, of the C
B-T
R-C
A conjugate (Example D). Thus a Spacer does not necessarily connect two entities together,
it may also be bound to only one component, e.g. the T
R or L
C. Alternatively, the Spacer may comprise a Spacer Unit linking C
A or C
B to T
R and in addition may comprise another Spacer Unit that is only bound to the Spacer
and serves to modulate the properties of the conjugate (Example F). The Spacer may
also consist of two different types of S
U constructs, e.g. a PEG linked to a peptide, or a PEG linked to an alkylene moiety
(Example E). For the sake of clarity, Example B depicts a S
U that is branched by using a multivalent branched S
U. Example C depicts a S
U that is branched by using a linear S
U polymer, such as a peptide, whose side chain residues serve as conjugation groups.

[0162] The Spacer may be bound to the Cleaving Agent in similar designs such as depicted
in above examples A- F.
[0163] The Spacer Units include but are not limited to amino acids, nucleosides, nucleotides,
and biopolymer fragments, such as oligo- or polypeptides, oligo- or polypeptoids,
or oligo- or polylactides, or oligo- or poly-carbohydrates, varying from 2 to 200,
particularly 2 to 113, preferably 2 to 50, more preferably 2 to 24 and more preferably
2 to 12 repeating units. Exemplary preferred biopolymer S
U are peptides.
[0164] Yet other examples are alkyl, alkylene, alkenyl, alkenylene, alkynyl, alkynylene,
cycloalkyl, cycloalkylene, cycloalkenyl, cycloalkenylene, cycloalkynyl, cycloalkynylene,
aryl, arylene, alkylaryl, alkylarylene, arylalkyl, arylalkylene, arylalkenyl, arylalkenylene,
arylalkynyl, arylalkynylene , polyethyleneamino, polyamine, which may be substituted
or unsubstituted, linear or branched, may contain further cyclic moieties and / or
heteroatoms, preferably O, N, and S, more preferably O; wherein in some embodiments
these example S
U comprise at most 50 carbon atoms, more preferably at most 25 carbon atoms, more preferably
at most 10 carbon atoms. In preferred embodiments the S
U is independently selected from the group consisting of (CH
2)
r, (C
3-C
8 carbocyclo), O-(CH
2)
r, arylene, (CH
2)
r-arylene, arylene-(CH
2)
r, (CH
2)
r -(C
3-C
8 carbocyclo), (C
3-C
8 carbocyclo)-(CH
2)
r, (C
3-C
8 heterocyclo, (CH
2)
r -(C
3-C
8 heterocyclo), (C
3-C
8 heterocyclo)-(CH
2)
r, - (CH
2)
rC(O)NR
4(CH
2)
r, (CH
2CH
2O)
r, (CH
2CH
2O)
rCH
2,(CH
2)
rC(O)NR
4(CH
2 CH
2O)
r, (CH
2)
rC(O)NR
4(CH
2CH
2O)
rCH
2, (CH
2CH
2O)
r C(O)NR
4(CH
2CH
2O)
r, (CH
2CH
2O)
r C(O)NR
4(CH
2CH
2O)
rCH
2, (CH
2CH
2O)
rC(O)NR
4CH
2, -(CH
2)
rC(O)NR
37(CH
2)
r, (CH
2CH
2O)
r, (CH
2CH
2O)
rCH
2,(CH
2)
rC(O)NR
37(CH
2 CH
2O)
r, (CH
2)
rC(O)NR
37(CH
2CH
2O)
rCH
2, (CH
2CH
2O)
r C(O)NR
37(CH
2CH
2O)
r , (CH
2CH
2O)
r C(O)NR
37(CH
2CH
2O)
rCH
2, (CH
2CH
2O)
rC(O)NR
37CH
2; wherein r is independently an integer from 1 -10, R
4 is as defined herein, and R
37 is as defined herein.
[0165] Other examples of Spacer Units S
U are linear or branched polyalkylene glycols such as polyethylene glycol (PEG) or
polypropylene glycol (PPG) chains varying from 2 to 200, particularly 2 to 113, preferably
2 to 50, more preferably 2 to 24 and more preferably 2 to 12 repeating units. It is
preferred that when polyalkylene glycols such as PEG and PPG polymers are only bound
via one end of the polymer chain, that the other end is terminated with -OCH
3, -OCH
2CH
3, - OCH
2CH
2CO
2H.
[0166] Other polymeric Spacer Units are polymers and copolymers such as poly-(2-oxazoline),
poly(N-(2-hydroxypropyl)methacrylamide) (HPMA), polylactic acid (PLA), polylactic-glycolic
acid (PLGA), polyglutamic acid (PG), dextran, polyvinylpyrrolidone (PVP), poly(1-hydroxymethylethylene
hydroxymethyl-formal (PHF). Other exemplary polymers are polysaccharides, glycopolysaccharides,
glycolipids, polyglycoside, polyacetals, polyketals, polyamides, polyethers, polyesters.
Examples of naturally occurring polysaccharides that can be used as S
U are cellulose, amylose, dextran, dextrin, levan, fucoidan, carraginan, inulin, pectin,
amylopectin, glycogen, lixenan, agarose, hyaluronan, chondroitinsulfate, dermatansulfate,
keratansulfate, alginic acid and heparin. In yet other exemplary embodiments, the
polymeric S
U comprises a copolymer of a polyacetal/polyketal and a hydrophilic polymer selected
from the group consisting of polyacrylates, polyvinyl polymers, polyesters, polyorthoesters,
polyamides, oligopeptides, polypeptides and derivatives thereof. Exemplary preferred
polymeric S
U are PEG, HPMA, PLA, PLGA, PVP, PHF, dextran, oligopeptides, and polypeptides.
[0167] In some aspects of the invention polymers used in a S
U have a molecular weight ranging from 2 to 200 kDa, from 2 to 100 kDa, from 2 to 80
kDa, from 2 to 60 kDa, from 2 to 40 kDa, from 2 to 20 kDa, from 3 to 15 kDa, from
5 to 10 kDa, from 500 dalton to 5 kDa.
[0168] Other exemplary S
U are dendrimers, such as poly(propylene imine) (PPI) dendrimers, PAMAM dendrimers,
and glycol based dendrimers.
[0169] The S
U of the invention expressly include but are not limited to conjugates prepared with
commercially available cross-linker reagents such as BMPEO, BMPS, EMCS, GMBS, HBVS,
LC-SMCC, MBS, MPBH, SBAP, SIA, SIAB, SMCC, SMPB, SMPH, sulfo-EMCS, sulfo-GMBS, sulfo-KMUS,
sulfo-MBS, sulfo-SIAB, sulfo-SMCC, sulfo-SMPB, and SVSB, DTME, BMB, BMDB, BMH, BMOE,
BM(PEO)
3 and BM(PEO)
4.
[0170] To construct a branching Spacer one may use a S
U based on one or several natural or non-natural amino acids, amino alcohol, aminoaldehyde,
or polyamine residues or combinations thereof that collectively provide the required
functionality for branching. For example serine has three functional groups, i.e.
acid, amino and hydroxyl groups and may be viewed as a combined amino acid an aminoalcohol
residue for purpose of acting as a branching S
U. Other exemplary amino acids are lysine and tyrosine.
[0171] In preferred embodiments, the Spacer consist of one Spacer Unit, therefore in those
cases S
P equals S
U. In preferred embodiments the Spacer consist of two, three or four Spacer Units.
[0172] In some aspects of the invention S
P has a molecular weight ranging from 2 to 200 kDa, from 2 to 100 kDa, from 2 to 80
kDa, from 2 to 60 kDa, from 2 to 40 kDa, from 2 to 20 kDa, from 3 to 15 kDa, from
5 to 10 kDa, from 500 dalton to 5 kDa. In some aspects of the invention, the S
P has a mass of no more than 5000 daltons, no more than 4000 daltons, no more than
3000 daltons, no more than 2000 daltons, no more than 1000 daltons, no more than 800
daltons, no more than 500 daltons, no more than 300 daltons, no more than 200 daltons.
In some aspects the S
P has a mass from 100 daltons, from 200 daltons, from 300 daltons to 5000 daltons.
In some aspects of the S
P has a mass from 30, 50, or 100 daltons to 1000 daltons, from 30, 50, or 100 daltons
to 500 daltons.
[0173] Preferably, each S
P is independently selected from the group consisting of R
97, -O-, -OC(O)-, -OC(O)-R
99-, -OC(S)-R
99-, -OR
97-, -OC(O)-R
97-, -OC(O)-R
99-R
97-, -OC(S)-R
99-R
97-, and L
C. In another preferred embodiment, S
P is not L
C when S
P is comprised in any one of X
1-X
4. In a preferred embodiment, S
P is not L
C.
[0174] In preferred embodiments, S
P comprises a residue of R
32, a moiety C
M2 or a moiety C
X; all as described herein. In preferred embodiments, said C
M2, C
X or a residue of R
32 connects the S
P to a Label, an Administration Agent, L
C, S
P, C
C, R
98, or T
R.
R97
[0175] In a preferred embodiment, each
R97 is independently selected from the group consisting of C
1-C
24 alkylene groups, C
2-C
24 alkenylene groups, C
2-C
24 alkynylene groups, C
6-C
24 arylene, C
2-C
24 heteroarylene, C
3-C
24 cycloalkylene groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkenylene groups, and C
12-C
24 cycloalkynylene groups, which are optionally further substituted with one or more
substituents selected from the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2, -NO
2, - CF
3, =O, =NR
36, -SR
36, C
1-C
24 alkyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
24 aryl groups, C
2-C
24 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
24 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkenyl groups, C
12-C
24 cycloalkynyl groups, C
3-C
24 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
24 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
24 (hetero)arylalkenyl groups, C
4-C
24 (hetero)arylalkynyl groups, C
4-C
24 alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
24 alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
24 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
6-C
24 alkylcycloalkenyl groups, C
13-C
24 alkylcycloalkynyl groups, C
4-C
24 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
6-C
24 cycloalkenylalkyl groups, C
13-C
24 cycloalkynylalkyl groups, C
5-C
24 alkenylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
24 alkenylcycloalkenyl groups, C
14-C
24 alkenylcycloalkynyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkylalkenyl groups, C
7-C
24 cycloalkenylalkenyl groups, C
14-C
24 cycloalkynylalkenyl groups, C
5-C
24 alkynylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
24 alkynylcycloalkenyl groups, C
14-C
24 alkynylcycloalkynyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkylalkynyl groups, C
7-C
24 cycloalkenylalkynyl groups, C
14-C
24 cycloalkynylalkynyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
7-C
24 cycloalkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
14-C
24 cycloalkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
5-C
24 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
24 (hetero)arylcycloalkenyl groups, and C
14-C
24 (hetero)arylcycloalkynyl groups, wherein the substituents optionally contain one
or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of O, S, NR
36, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized; and wherein preferably the alkylene groups, alkenylene
groups, alkynylene groups, cycloalkylene groups, cycloalkenylene groups, and cycloalkynylene
groups optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of O, S, NR
36, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0176] In a preferred embodiment, each
R97 is independently selected from the group consisting of C
1-C
12 alkylene groups, C
2-C
12 alkenylene groups, C
2-C
12 alkynylene groups, C
6-C
12 arylene, C
2-C
12 heteroarylene, C
3-C
12 cycloalkylene groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkenylene groups, and C
12 cycloalkynylene groups; and wherein preferably the alkylene groups, alkenylene groups,
alkynylene groups, cycloalkylene groups, cycloalkenylene groups, and cycloalkynylene
groups optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of O, S, NR
36, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0177] In a preferred embodiment, each
R97 is independently selected from the group consisting of C
1-C
6 alkylene groups, C
2-C
6 alkenylene groups, C
2-C
6 alkynylene groups, C
6-C
6 arylene, C
2-C
6 heteroarylene, C
3-C
6 cycloalkylene groups, and C
5-C
6 cycloalkenylene groups; and wherein preferably the alkylene groups, alkenylene groups,
alkynylene groups, cycloalkylene groups, cycloalkenylene groups, and cycloalkynylene
groups optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of O, S, NR
36, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0178] In a preferred embodiment, the R
97 groups are optionally further substituted with one or more substituents selected
from the group consisting of - Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NR
36, -SR
36, C
1-C
12 alkyl groups, C
2-C
12 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
12 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
12 aryl groups, C
2-C
12 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
12 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkenyl groups, C
12 cycloalkynyl groups, C
3-C
12 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
12 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 (hetero)arylalkenyl groups, C
4-C
12 (hetero)arylalkynyl groups, C
4-C
12 alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
12 alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
12 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
6-C
12 alkylcycloalkenyl groups, C
13-C
18 alkylcycloalkynyl groups, C
4-C
12 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
6-C
12 cycloalkenylalkyl groups, C
13-C
18 cycloalkynylalkyl groups, C
5-C
12 alkenylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
12 alkenylcycloalkenyl groups, C
14-C
16 alkenylcycloalkynyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkylalkenyl groups, C
7-C
12 cycloalkenylalkenyl groups, C
14-C
16 cycloalkynylalkenyl groups, C
5-C
12 alkynylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
12 alkynylcycloalkenyl groups, C
14-C
16 alkynylcycloalkynyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkylalkynyl groups, C
7-C
12 cycloalkenylalkynyl groups, C
14-C
16 cycloalkynylalkynyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
7-C
12 cycloalkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
14-C
16 cycloalkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
5-C
12 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
12 (hetero)arylcycloalkenyl groups, and C
14-C
16 (hetero)arylcycloalkynyl groups, wherein the substituents optionally contain one
or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of O, S, NR
36, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0179] In preferred embodiments, the R
97 groups are optionally further substituted with one or more substituents selected
from the group consisting of - Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NR
36, -SR
36, C
1-C
6 alkyl groups, C
2-C
6 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
6 alkynyl groups, C
6 aryl groups, C
2-C
6 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
6 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
6 cycloalkenyl groups, C
3-C
6 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
6 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
6 (hetero)arylalkenyl groups, C
4-C
6 (hetero)arylalkynyl groups, C
4-C
6 alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
6 alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
6 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
6 alkylcycloalkenyl groups, C
4-C
6 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
6 cycloalkenylalkyl groups, C
5-C
6 alkenylcycloalkyl groups, C
7 alkenylcycloalkenyl groups, C
5-C
6 cycloalkylalkenyl groups, C
7 cycloalkenylalkenyl groups, C
5-C
6 alkynylcycloalkyl groups, C
7 alkynylcycloalkenyl groups, C
5-C
6 cycloalkylalkynyl groups, C
5-C
6 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups, and C
5-C
6 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, wherein the substituents optionally contain one or
more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of O, S, NR
36, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0180] In preferred embodiments, the R
97 groups are optionally further substituted with one or more substituents selected
from the group consisting of - Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NR
36, -SR
36, C
1-C
6 alkyl groups, C
2-C
6 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
6 alkynyl groups, C
6 aryl groups, C
2-C
6 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
6 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
6 cycloalkenyl groups, C
3-C
7 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
7 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
8 (hetero)arylalkenyl groups, C
4-C
8 (hetero)arylalkynyl groups, C
4-C
8 alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
8 alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
6 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
6-C
7 alkylcycloalkenyl groups, C
4-C
6 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
6-C
7 cycloalkenylalkyl groups, C
5-C
6 alkenylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
8 alkenylcycloalkenyl groups, C
5-C
6 cycloalkylalkenyl groups, C
7-C
8 cycloalkenylalkenyl groups, C
5-C
6 alkynylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
8 alkynylcycloalkenyl groups, C
5-C
6 cycloalkylalkynyl groups, C
5-C
9 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups, and C
5-C
9 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, wherein the substituents optionally contain one or
more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of O, S, NR
36, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0181] In a preferred embodiment, the R
97 groups are not substituted. In a preferred embodiment, the R
97 groups do not contain a heteroatom.
Linker LC
[0182] L
C is an optional self-immolative linker, which may consist of multiple units arranged
linearly and/or branched and may release one or more C
A moieties.
[0183] It will be understood that if L
C comprises more than one C
A moiety, these C
A moieties can independently be Label or Administration Agent, optionally linked to
L
C via a spacer S
P, since both are released due to the self-immolative character of L
C. Preferably, if L
C comprises more than one C
B, then said C
B moieties are all either Administration Agent or Label.
[0184] By way of further clarification, if R
48 is L
B and all d and e in Formula (2) are 0, the Label directly constitutes the leaving
group of the release reaction, and if one of d or e in Formula (2) is 1, S
L, which may be a self-immolative linker L
C, constitutes the leaving group of the release reaction. The possible L
C structures, their use, position and ways of attachment of linkers L
C , constructs C
A and C
B , and the T
R are known to the skilled person, see for example [
Papot et al., Anticancer Agents Med. Chem., 2008, 8, 618-637]. Nevertheless, typical but nonlimiting examples of self-immolative linkers L
C are benzyl-derivatives, such as those drawn below. There are two main self-immolation
mechanisms: electron cascade elimination and cyclization-mediated elimination. The
preferred example below on the left functions by means of the cascade mechanism, wherein
the bond to the Y
C between Trigger and L
C, here termed Y
C1, is cleaved, and an electron pair of Y
C1, for example an electron pair of NR
6, shifts into the benzyl moiety resulting in an electron cascade and the formation
of 4-hydroxybenzyl alcohol, CO
2 and the liberated C
A also comprising an Y
C, here termed Y
C2. The preferred example in the middle functions by means of the cyclization mechanism,
wherein cleavage of the bond to the amine of Y
C1 leads to nucleophilic attack of the amine on the carbonyl, forming a 5-ring 1,3-dimethylimidazolidin-2-one
and liberating the C
A including Y
C2. The preferred example on the right combines both mechanisms, this linker will degrade
not only into CO
2 and one unit of 4-hydroxybenzyl alcohol (when Y
C1 is O), but also into one 1,3-dimethylimidazolidin-2-one unit.

[0185] Herein, C
A is optionally linked to the remainder of L
C via a spacer S
P.
[0186] By substituting the benzyl groups of aforementioned self-immolative linkers L
C, it is possible to tune the rate of release of the construct C
A, caused by either steric and/or electronic effects on the cyclization and/or cascade
release. Synthetic procedures to prepare such substituted benzyl-derivatives are known
to the skilled person (see for example [
Greenwald et al, J. Med. Chem., 1999, 42, 3657-3667] and [
Thornthwaite et al, Polym. Chem., 2011, 2, 773-790]. Preferred substituted benzyl-derivatives with different release rates are drawn
below.

[0187] Herein, C
A is optionally linked to the remainder of L
C via a spacer S
P.
[0188] In preferred embodiments the L
C satisfies one of the following Formulae 23a-c

wherein Y
C1 is O, S or NR
6; V, U, W, Z are each independently CR
7 or N; Y
C2 is O, S, secondary amine or tertiary amine, wherein these Y
C2 moieties are part of C
A; with R
6, R
7, R
8, R
9 as defined herein, and wherein, C
A is optionally linked to the remainder of L
C via a spacer S
P.
[0189] In preferred embodiments it is preferred that R
6 is H or methyl, R
7 is H, R
8 is H or methyl and R
9 is H. In preferred embodiments the R
7 comprised in Formula 23c is CF
3 and Z is N.
[0190] In preferred embodiments the L
C satisfies the following Formula 23d

wherein Y
C1 is O, S or NR
6; Y
C2 is O, S, secondary amine or tertiary amine, wherein these Y
C2 moieties are part of C
A; with R
6, R
7, R
8, R
9 as defined herein; preferably R
7 is C
1-C
8 alkyl, C
6-C
12 aryl, C
1-C
8 O-alkyl, C
6-C
12 O-aryl , NO
2, F, Cl, Br, I, CN, with m being an integer from 0 to 4; preferably each R
8 and R
9 are independently H, C
1-C
8 alkyl, C
6-C
12 aryl, C
1-C
8 O-alkyl, C
6-C
12 O-aryl , NO
2, F, Cl, Br, I, CN; and wherein, C
A is optionally linked to the remainder of L
C via a spacer S
P. Preferably R
7 is electron donating and preferably m is an integer between 0 and 2, more preferably
m is 0. Preferably R
8 is H and R
9 is H or methyl.
[0191] Self-immolative linkers that undergo cyclization include but are not limited to substituted
and unsubstituted aminobutyric acid amide, appropriately substituted bicyclo[2.2.1]
and bicyclo[2.2.2] ring system, 2-aminophenylpropionic acid amides, and trimethyl
lock-based linkers, see e.g. [
Chem. Biol. 1995, 2, 223], [
J. Am. Chem. Soc. 1972, 94, 5815], [
J. Org. Chem. 1990, 55, 5867]. Preferably, with an L
C that releases C
A by means of cyclization, the remainder of C
A is bound to L
C via Y
C1 being an aromatic oxygen of sulfur. It will be understood that e.g. aromatic oxygen
means an oxygen that is directly attached to an aromatic group.
[0192] In preferred embodiments such cyclization L
C satisfies one of the following Formulae 24a-f.

[0193] Wherein Y
C1 is NR
6; Y
C2 is O or S, wherein these Y
C2 moieties are part of C
A; a is independently 0 or 1; R
6 and R
7 are as defined herein, and wherein, C
A is optionally linked to the remainder of L
C via a spacer S
P. Preferably R
6 and R
7 are H, unsubstituted C
1-C
8 alkyl, C
6 aryl, more preferably R
6 is H or methyl and R
7 is H.
[0194] In a preferred embodiment, the remainder of C
A in Formula 24a, 24b, 24c, 24d and 24e is bound to Y
C2 via an aromatic moiety, said moiety being a part of C
A. In a preferred embodiment, the remainder of C
A in Formula 24f is bound to Y
C2 via an aliphatic moiety, said moiety being a part of C
A.
[0195] Several preferred structures of L
C are shown below. In these examples C
A is preferably bound to L
C via an Y
C2 that is O or S, wherein O or S is part of C
A. For the avoidance of doubt, in these examples Y
C1 is not denoted as such but is embodied by the relevant NH, NR
6, S, O groups.

[0196] Herein, C
A is optionally linked to the remainder of L
C via a spacer S
P; and R
6 is as defined herein
[0197] Several other preferred structures of L
C are shown below. In these examples C
A is preferably bound to L
C via an Y
C2 that is a secondary or primary amine, and wherein said Y
C2 is part of C
A. For the avoidance of doubt, in these examples Y
C1 is not denoted as such but is embodied by the relevant NH, NR
6, S, O groups, and C
A is optionally linked to the remainder of L
C via a spacer S
P.

[0198] Herein, R
6 is as defined herein.
[0200] In preferred embodiments of the invention the L
C has a mass of no more than 1000 daltons, no more than 500 daltons, no more than 400
daltons, no more than 300 daltons, or from 10, 50 or 100 to 1000 daltons, from 10,
50, 100 to 400 daltons, from 10, 50, 100 to 300 daltons, from 10, 50, 100 to 200 daltons,
e.g., 10-1000 daltons, such as 50-500 daltons, such as 100 to 400 daltons.
[0201] A person skilled in the art will know that one L
C may be connected to another L
C that is bound to C
A, wherein upon reaction of the Cleaving Agent with the Trigger T
R, L
C-L
C-C
A is released from the T
R, leading to self-immolative release of both L
C moieties and the C
A moiety. With respect to the L
C formulas disclosed herein, the L
C linking the T
R to the other L
C then does not release C
A but an L
C that is bound via Y
C1 and further links to a C
A.
[0202] R
6, R
7, R
8, R
9 are as defined herein.
[0203] In a preferred embodiment, L
C is selected from the group consisting of linkers according to Group I, Group II,
and Group III,
wherein linkers according to Group I are

, wherein U, V, W, Z are each independently selected from the group consisting of
-CR
7-, and -N-. Herein, e is either 0 or 1, and X is selected from the group consisting
of -O-, -S- and -NR
6-. Preferably, each R
8 and R
9 are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C
1-C
4 alkyl groups, C
2-C
4 alkenyl groups, and C
4-6 (hetero)aryl groups, wherein for R
8 and R
9 the alkyl groups, alkenyl groups, and (hetero)aryl groups are optionally substituted
with a moiety selected from the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, =O, -SH, -SO
3H, - PO
3H, -PO
4H
2 and -NO
2 and optionally contain at most two heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of -O-, -S-, -NH-, -P-, and -Si-, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized.
[0204] For linkers according to Group I C
A is linked to L
C via a moiety selected from the group consisting of -O-, -N-, -C-, and -S-, preferably
from the group consisting of secondary amines and tertiary amines, wherein said moieties
are part of C
A.
[0205] The linker according to Group II is

, wherein m is an integer between 0 and 2, preferably m is 0, and wherein e is either
0 or 1. For linkers according to Group II C
A is linked to L
C via a moiety selected from the group consisting of -O-, -N-, -C-, and -S-, preferably
from the group consisting of secondary amines and tertiary amines, wherein said moieties
are part of C
A.
[0206] Linkers according to Group III are

wherein for linkers according to Group III C
A is linked to L
C via a moiety selected from the group consisting of -O- and -S-, preferably -O- or
-S- bound to a C
4-6 (hetero)aryl group, wherein said moieties are part of C
A.
[0207] For linkers according to Groups I-III preferably each R
6 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C
1-C
4 alkyl groups, C
2-C
4 alkenyl groups, and C
4-6 (hetero)aryl groups, wherein for R
6 the alkyl groups, alkenyl groups, and (hetero)aryl groups are optionally substituted
with a moiety selected from the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, =O, -SH, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, - PO
4H
2 and -NO
2 and optionally contain at most two heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of -O-, -S-, -NH-, -P-, and -Si-, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized.
[0208] For linkers of Groups I-III preferably each R
7 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and C
1-C
3 alkyl groups, C
2-C
3 alkenyl groups, and C
4-6 (hetero)aryl groups, wherein for R
7 the alkyl groups, alkenyl groups, and (hetero)aryl groups are optionally substituted
with a moiety selected from the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, =O, =NH, -N(CH
3)
2, - S(O)
2CH
3, and -SH, and are optionally interrupted by at most one heteroatom selected from
the group consisting of -O-, -S-, -NH-, -P-, and -Si-, wherein the N, S, and P atoms
are optionally oxidized, wherein the N atoms are optionally quaternized, wherein R
7 is preferably selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, -CH
2-CH
2-N(CH
3)
2, and -CH
2-CH
2-S(O)
2-CH
3.
[0209] R
6, R
7, R
8, R
9 comprised in said Group I, II and III, can optionally also be - (S
P)
i-C
B.
[0210] For all linkers according to Group I and Group II Y
C1 is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S-, and -NR
6-, preferably -NR
6-. For all linkers according to Group III, Y
C1 is -NR
6-. For all linkers according to Group I, Group II, and Group III, Y
C2 is selected from the group consisting of O and S, preferably O.
[0211] Preferably, in Groups I-III when two L
C are linked to each other, then the L
C attached to the -O- or -S- at the allylic position of the trans-cyclooctene is selected
from the group consisting of linkers according to Group I and Group II, and the L
C between the L
C attached to the -O- or -S- at the allylic position of the trans-cyclooctene and C
A is selected from Group III, and that the wiggly line in the structures of Group III
then denotes a bond to the L
C attached to the -O- or -S- at the allylic position of the trans-cyclooctene instead
of a bond to the allylic -O- or -S- on the trans-cyclooctene ring, and that the double
dashed line in the structures of Groups I and II then denotes a bond to the L
C between the L
C attached to the -O- or -S- at the allylic position of the trans-cyclooctene and the
C
A instead of a bond to C
A.
[0212] In preferred embodiments, L
C is selected from the group consisting of linkers according to Group IV, Group V,
Group VI, and Group VII.
[0213] Linkers according to Group IV are

, wherein C
A is linked to L
C via a moiety selected from the group consisting of -O- and -S-, preferably from the
group consisting of -O-C
5-8-arylene- and -S-C
5-8-arylene-, wherein said moieties are part of C
A.
[0214] Linkers according to Group V are

, wherein C
A is linked to L
C via a moiety selected from the group consisting of -O- and -S-, wherein said moieties
are part of C
A.
[0215] Linkers according to Group VI are

, wherein C
A is linked to L
C via a moiety selected from the group consisting of -O-, -N-, and -S-, preferably
a secondary or a tertiary amine, wherein said moieties are part of C
A.
[0216] Linkers according to Group VII are

, wherein C
A is linked to L
C via a moiety selected from the group consisting of -O-, -N-, and -S-, preferably
from the group consisting of secondary amines and tertiary amines, wherein said moieties
are part of C
A, wherein when multiple double dashed lines are shown within one L
C, each C
A moiety is independently selected.
[0217] For all linkers according to Group IV, Group V, Group VI, and Group VII, Y
C1 is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S-, and -NR
6-. For all linkers according to Groups IV-VII R
6 and R
7 are as defined herein; i is an integer in a range of from 0 to 4, preferably 0 or
1; and j is 0 or 1.
[0218] In preferred embodiments, R
6, R
7, R
8 and R
9 in L
C formulas, in particular in any one of Groups I-VII, are hydrogen.
R6
[0219] Preferably, each R
6 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, -(S
P)
i-C
C, C
1-C
24 alkyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
24 aryl groups, C
2-C
24 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
24 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkenyl groups, C
12-C
24 cycloalkynyl groups, C
3-C
24 (cyclo)alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkyl, C
4-C
24 (cyclo)alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkenyl groups, C
4-C
24 (cyclo)alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkynyl groups, C
4-C
24 alkylcycloalkyl groups, and C
4-C
24 cycloalkylalkyl groups; wherein i is an integer in a range of from 0 to 4, preferably
i is 1;
the R
6 groups not being hydrogen are optionally substituted with a moiety selected from
the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, - PO
4H
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NH, and -SH, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the
group consisting of O, S, NH, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally
oxidized, wherein the N atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0220] In preferred embodiments, each R
6 is individually selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C
1-C
8 alkyl groups, C
2-C
8 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
8 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
12 aryl, C
2-C
12 heteroaryl, C
3-C
8 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
8 cycloalkenyl groups, C
3-C
12 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
12 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups and C
5-C
12 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, wherein the R
6 groups not being hydrogen are optionally substituted with a moiety selected from
the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, - PO
4H
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NH, and -SH, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the
group consisting of O, S, NH, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally
oxidized, wherein the N atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0221] In preferred embodiments, R
6 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C
1-C
4 alkyl groups, C
2-C
4 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
4 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
8 aryl, C
2-C
8 heteroaryl, C
3-C
6 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
6 cycloalkenyl groups, C
3-C
10 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
10 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
8 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
4-C
8 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
5-C
10 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups and C
5-C
10 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, wherein the R
6 groups not being hydrogen are optionally substituted with a moiety selected from
the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NH, and -SH, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the
group consisting of O, S, NH, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally
oxidized, wherein the N atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0222] In preferred embodiments, R
6 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C
1-C
4 alkyl groups, C
2-C
4 alkenyl groups, and C
4-6 (hetero)aryl groups, wherein for R
6 the alkyl groups, alkenyl groups, and (hetero)aryl groups are optionally substituted
with a moiety selected from the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, =O, -SH, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2 and -NO
2 and optionally contain at most two heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of -O-, -S-, - NH-, -P-, and -Si-, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized.
[0223] In preferred embodiments, R
6 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C
1-C
3 alkyl groups, C
2-C
3 alkenyl groups, and C
4-6 (hetero)aryl groups, wherein for R
6 the alkyl groups, alkenyl groups, and (hetero)aryl groups are optionally substituted
with a moiety selected from the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, =O, -SH, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2 and -NO
2 and optionally contain at most two heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of -O-, -S-, - NH-, -P-, and -Si-, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized.
[0224] In preferred embodiments, the R
6 groups not being hydrogen are not substituted. In preferred embodiments, the R
6 groups not being hydrogen do not contain heteroatoms. In preferred embodiments, the
R
6 groups are hydrogen.
R7
[0225] In preferred embodiments, each R
7 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, -(S
P)
i-C
C , -F, -Cl, -Br, -I, -OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, -SO
3, -PO
3-, -NO
2, -CF
3, -SR
37, S(=O)
2N(R
37)
2, OC(=O)R
37, SC(=O) R
37, OC(=S)R
37, SC(=S)R
37, NR
37C(=O)-R
37, NR
37C(=S)-R
37, NR
37C(=O)O-R
37, NR
37C(=S)O-R
37, NR
37C(=O)S-R
37, NR
37C(=S)S-R
37, OC(=O)N(R
37)
2, SC(=O)N(R
37)
2, OC(=S)N(R
37)
2, SC(=S)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=O)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)R
37, C(=S)R
37, C(=O)N(R
37)
2, C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)O-R
37, C(=O)S-R
37, C(=S)O-R
37, C(=S)S-R
37, S(O)R
37, -S(O)
2R
37, NR
37S(O)
2R
37, -ON(R
37)
2,
-NR
37OR
37, C
1-C
24 alkyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
24 aryl groups, C
2-C
24 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
24 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkenyl groups, C
12-C
24 cycloalkynyl groups, C
3-C
24 (cyclo)alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkyl, C
4-C
24 (cyclo)alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkenyl groups, C
4-C
24 (cyclo)alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkynyl groups, C
4-C
24 alkylcycloalkyl groups, and C
4-C
24 cycloalkylalkyl groups; wherein i is an integer in a range of from 0 to 4, preferably
i is 1, wherein the alkyl groups, alkenyl groups, alkynyl groups, aryl, heteroaryl,
cycloalkyl groups, cycloalkenyl groups, cycloalkynyl groups, (cyclo)alkyl(hetero)aryl
groups, (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkyl groups, (cyclo)alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkenyl
groups, (cyclo)alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkynyl groups, alkylcycloalkyl
groups, cycloalkylalkyl groups are optionally substituted with a moiety selected from
the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, - SO
3R
37, -PO
3(R
37)
2, -PO
4(R
37)
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NR
37, and -SR
37, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of O, S, NR
37, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0226] In preferred embodiments, each R
7 is independently selected from the group consisting hydrogen, -F, -Cl, -Br, -I, -OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, -SO
3, -PO
3-, -NO
2, -CF
3, -SR
37, S(=O)
2N(R
37)
2, OC(=O)R
37, SC(=O) R
37, OC(=S)R
37, SC(=S)R
37, NR
37C(=O)-R
37, NR
37C(=S)-R
37, NR
37C(=O)O-R
37, NR
37C(=S)O-R
37, NR
37C(=O)S-R
37, NR
37C(=S)S-R
37, OC(=O)N(R
37)
2, SC(=O)N(R
37)
2, OC(=S)N(R
37)
2, SC(=S)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=O)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)R
37, C(=S)R
37, C(=O)N(R
37)
2, C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)O-R
37, C(=O)S-R
37, C(=S)O-R
37, C(=S)S-R
37, S(O)R
37, - S(O)
2R
37, NR
37S(O)
2R
37, -ON(R
37)
2,
-NR
37OR
37, C
1-C
8 alkyl groups, C
2-C
8 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
8 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
12 aryl groups, C
2-C
12 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
8 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
8 cycloalkenyl groups, C
3-C
12 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
12 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups and C
5-C
12 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, wherein the alkyl groups, alkenyl groups, alkynyl
groups, aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl groups, cycloalkenyl groups, alkyl(hetero)aryl
groups, (hetero)arylalkyl groups, alkylcycloalkyl groups, cycloalkylalkyl groups,
cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups and (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups are optionally substituted
with a moiety selected from the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, - OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, -SO
3R
37, -PO
3(R
37)
2, -PO
4(R
37)
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NR
37, and -SR
37, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of O, S, NR
37, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0227] In preferred embodiments, each R
7 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, -F, -Cl, -Br, -I,
-OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, -SO
3, -PO
3-, -NO
2, - CF
3, -SR
37, S(=O)
2N(R
37)
2, OC(=O)R
37, SC(=O) R
37, OC(=S)R
37, SC(=S)R
37, NR
37C(=O)-R
37, NR
37C(=S)-R
37, NR
37C(=O)O-R
37, NR
37C(=S)O-R
37, NR
37C(=O)S-R
37, NR
37C(=S)S-R
37, OC(=O)N(R
37)
2, SC(=O)N(R
37)
2, OC(=S)N(R
37)
2, SC(=S)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=O)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)R
37, C(=S)R
37, C(=O)N(R
37)
2, C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)O-R
37, C(=O)S-R
37, C(=S)O-R
37, C(=S)S-R
37, S(O)R
37, -S(O)
2R
37, NR
37S(O)
2R
37, -ON(R
37)
2,
-NR
37OR
37, C
1-C
4 alkyl groups, C
2-C
4 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
4 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
8 aryl groups, C
2-C
8 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
6 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
6 cycloalkenyl groups, C
3-C
10 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
10 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
10 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
4-C
10 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
5-C
10 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups and C
5-C
10 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, wherein the alkyl groups, alkenyl groups, alkynyl
groups, aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl groups, cycloalkenyl groups, alkyl(hetero)aryl
groups, (hetero)arylalkyl groups, alkylcycloalkyl groups, cycloalkylalkyl groups,
cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups and (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups are optionally substituted
with a moiety selected from the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, - OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, -SO
3R
37, -PO
3(R
37)
2, -PO
4(R
37)
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NR
37, and -SR
37, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of O, S, NR
37, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0228] In preferred embodiments, each R
7 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and C
1-C
3 alkyl groups, C
2-C
3 alkenyl groups, and C
4-6 (hetero)aryl groups, wherein the alkyl groups, alkenyl groups, and (hetero)aryl groups
are optionally substituted with a moiety selected from the group consisting of -Cl,
-F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, =O, =NH, -N(CH
3)
2, -S(O)
2CH
3, and -SH, and are optionally interrupted by at most one heteroatom selected from
the group consisting of -O-, -S-, -NH-, -P-, and -Si-, wherein the N, S, and P atoms
are optionally oxidized, wherein the N atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0229] In preferred embodiments, R
7 is preferably selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, -CH
2-CH
2-N(CH
3)
2, and -CH
2-CH
2-S(O)
2-CH
3. In preferred embodiments, the R
7 groups not being hydrogen are not substituted. In preferred embodiments, the R
7 groups not being hydrogen do not contain heteroatoms. In preferred embodiments, the
R
7 groups are hydrogen.
R8 and R9
[0230] R
8 and R
9 are as defined for R
7. In preferred embodiments, at least one or all R
8 are -H. In preferred embodiments, at least one or all R
8 are -CH
3. In preferred embodiments, at least one or all R
9 are -H. In preferred embodiments, at least one or all R
9 are -CH
3. In preferred embodiments, the R
8 and R
9 groups not being hydrogen are not substituted. In preferred embodiments, the R
8 and R
9 groups not being hydrogen do not contain heteroatoms. In preferred embodiments, the
R
8 and R
9 groups are hydrogen.
X1, X2, X3, X4, and X5
[0231] In Formula (1), each X
1, X
2, X
3, X
4 is independently selected from the group consisting of -C(R
47)
2-, -NR
37-, -C(O)-, -O-, such that at most two of X
1, X
2, X
3, X
4 are not -C(R
47)
2-, and with the proviso that no sets consisting of adjacent atoms are present selected
from the group consisting of -O-O-, -O-N-, -C(O)-O-, N-N-, and -C(O)-C(O)-.
[0232] In a preferred embodiment, X
1, X
2, X
3, and X
4 are -C(R
47)
2-, and preferably at most four R
47, more preferably at most two R
47, most preferably at most one R
47, are not H. In Formula (1) X
5 is -C(R
47)
2- or -CHR
48. In a preferred embodiment, X
5 is -C(R
47)
2-; more preferably X
5 is -CHR
47, and most preferably X
5 is -CH
2. In a preferred embodiment X
5 is CHR
48.
R36
[0233] In a preferred embodiment, R
36 is as defined for R
37.
[0234] In Formula (1) R
36 is preferably selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C
1-C
8 alkyl groups, C
2-C
8 alkenyl groups, and C
4-6 (hetero)aryl groups, wherein the alkyl groups, alkenyl groups, and (hetero)aryl groups
are optionally substituted with a moiety selected from the group consisting of -Cl,
-F, -Br, -I, - OH, -NH
2, =O, -SH, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2 and -NO
2 and optionally contain at most two heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of -O-, -S-, -NH-, -P-, and -Si-, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized.
In preferred embodiments, the R
36 groups not being hydrogen are not substituted. In preferred embodiments, the R
36 groups not being hydrogen do not contain heteroatoms. In some preferred embodiments,
R
36 is hydrogen.
R47
[0235] In Formula (1) each R
47 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, -L
B, -L
A, -(S
P)
i-C
C, -F, -Cl, -Br, -I, -OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, -SO
3, -PO
3-, -NO
2, - CF
3, -SR
37, S(=O)
2N(R
37)
2, OC(=O)R
37, SC(=O) R
37, OC(=S)R
37, SC(=S)R
37, NR
37C(=O)-R
37, NR
37C(=S)-R
37, NR
37C(=O)O-R
37, NR
37C(=S)O-R
37, NR
37C(=O)S-R
37, NR
37C(=S)S-R
37, OC(=O)N(R
37)
2, SC(=O)N(R
37)
2, OC(=S)N(R
37)
2, SC(=S)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=O)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)R
37, C(=S)R
37, C(=O)N(R
37)
2, C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)O-R
37, C(=O)S-R
37, C(=S)O-R
37, C(=S)S-R
37, S(O)R
37, -S(O)
2R
37, NR
37S(O)
2R
37, -ON(R
37)
2,
-NR
37OR
37, C
1-C
24 alkyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
24 aryl groups, C
2-C
24 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
24 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkenyl groups, C
12-C
24 cycloalkynyl groups, C
3-C
24 (cyclo)alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkyl, C
4-C
24 (cyclo)alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkenyl groups, C
4-C
24 (cyclo)alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkynyl groups, C
4-C
24 alkylcycloalkyl groups, and C
4-C
24 cycloalkylalkyl groups; wherein i is an integer in a range of from 0 to 4, preferably
i is an integer ranging from 0 to 1, wherein the alkyl groups, alkenyl groups, alkynyl
groups, aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl groups, cycloalkenyl groups, cycloalkynyl groups,
(cyclo)alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkyl groups, (cyclo)alkenyl(hetero)aryl
groups, (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkenyl groups, (cyclo)alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkynyl
groups, alkylcycloalkyl groups, cycloalkylalkyl groups are optionally substituted
with a moiety selected from the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, - SO
3R
37, -PO
3(R
37)
2, -PO
4(R
37)
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NR
37, and -SR
37, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of O, S, NR
37, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0236] In preferred embodiments, each R
47 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, -L
B, -L
A, -(S
P)
i-C
C, -F, -Cl, -Br, -I, -OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, - SO
3, -PO
3-, -NO
2, -CF
3, -SR
37, S(=O)
2N(R
37)
2, OC(=O)R
37, SC(=O) R
37, OC(=S)R
37, SC(=S)R
37, NR
37C(=O)-R
37, NR
37C(=S)-R
37, NR
37C(=O)O-R
37, NR
37C(=S)O-R
37, NR
37C(=O)S-R
37, NR
37C(=S)S-R
37, OC(=O)N(R
37)
2, SC(=O)N(R
37)
2, OC(=S)N(R
37)
2, SC(=S)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=O)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)R
37, C(=S)R
37, C(=O)N(R
37)
2, C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)O-R
37, C(=O)S-R
37, C(=S)O-R
37, C(=S)S-R
37, S(O)R
37, -S(O)
2R
37, NR
37S(O)
2R
37, -ON(R
37)
2,
-NR
37OR
37, C
1-C
8 alkyl groups, C
2-C
8 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
8 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
12 aryl groups, C
2-C
12 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
8 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
8 cycloalkenyl groups, C
3-C
12 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
12 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups and C
5-C
12 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, wherein the alkyl groups, alkenyl groups, alkynyl
groups, aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl groups, cycloalkenyl groups, alkyl(hetero)aryl
groups, (hetero)arylalkyl groups, alkylcycloalkyl groups, cycloalkylalkyl groups,
cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups and (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups are optionally substituted
with a moiety selected from the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, -SO
3R
37, -PO
3(R
37)
2, -PO
4(R
37)
2, -NO
2, - CF
3, =O, =NR
37, and -SR
37, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of O, S, NR
37, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0237] In preferred embodiments, each R
47 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, -L
B, -L
A, -(S
P)
i-C
C, -F, -Cl, -Br, -I, -OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, - SO
3, -PO
3-, -NO
2, -CF
3, -SR
37, S(=O)
2N(R
37)
2, OC(=O)R
37, SC(=O) R
37, OC(=S)R
37, SC(=S)R
37, NR
37C(=O)-R
37, NR
37C(=S)-R
37, NR
37C(=O)O-R
37, NR
37C(=S)O-R
37, NR
37C(=O)S-R
37, NR
37C(=S)S-R
37, OC(=O)N(R
37)
2, SC(=O)N(R
37)
2, OC(=S)N(R
37)
2, SC(=S)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=O)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)R
37, C(=S)R
37, C(=O)N(R
37)
2, C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)O-R
37, C(=O)S-R
37, C(=S)O-R
37, C(=S)S-R
37, S(O)R
37, -S(O)
2R
37, NR
37S(O)
2R
37, -ON(R
37)
2,
-NR
37OR
37, C
1-C
4 alkyl groups, C
2-C
4 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
4 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
8 aryl groups, C
2-C
8 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
6 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
6 cycloalkenyl groups, C
3-C
10 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
10 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
10 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
4-C
10 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
5-C
10 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups and C
5-C
10 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, wherein the alkyl groups, alkenyl groups, alkynyl
groups, aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl groups, cycloalkenyl groups, alkyl(hetero)aryl
groups, (hetero)arylalkyl groups, alkylcycloalkyl groups, cycloalkylalkyl groups,
cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups and (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups are optionally substituted
with a moiety selected from the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, - OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, -SO
3R
37, -PO
3(R
37)
2, -PO
4(R
37)
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NR
37, and -SR
37, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of O, S, NR
37, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
R37
[0238] In Formula (1) each R
37 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, -L
B, -L
A, -(S
P)
i-C
C, C
1-C
24 alkyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
24 aryl groups, C
2-C
24 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
24 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkenyl groups, C
12-C
24 cycloalkynyl groups, C
3-C
24 (cyclo)alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkyl, C
4-C
24 (cyclo)alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkenyl groups, C
4-C
24 (cyclo)alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkynyl groups, C
4-C
24 alkylcycloalkyl groups, and C
4-C
24 cycloalkylalkyl groups; wherein i is an integer in a range of from 0 to 4, preferably
i is 1; the R
37 groups not being hydrogen are optionally substituted with a moiety selected from
the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NH, and -SH, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the
group consisting of O, S, NH, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally
oxidized, wherein the N atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0239] In preferred embodiments, R
37 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, -L
B, -L
A, -(S
P)
i-C
C, C
1-C
8 alkyl groups, C
2-C
8 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
8 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
12 aryl, C
2-C
12 heteroaryl, C
3-C
8 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
8 cycloalkenyl groups, C
3-C
12 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
12 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups and C
5-C
12 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, wherein the R
37 groups not being hydrogen are optionally substituted with a moiety selected from
the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, -SO
3H, -PO
3H,-PO
4H
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NH, and -SH, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the
group consisting of O, S, NH, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally
oxidized, wherein the N atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0240] In preferred embodiments, R
37 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, -L
B, -L
A, -(S
P)
i-C
C, C
1-C
4 alkyl groups, C
2-C
4 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
4 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
8 aryl, C
2-C
8 heteroaryl, C
3-C
6 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
6 cycloalkenyl groups, C
3-C
10 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
10 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
8 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
4-C
8 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
5-C
10 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups and C
5-C
10 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, wherein the R
37 groups not being hydrogen are optionally substituted with a moiety selected from
the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, -SO
3H, -PO
3H,-PO
4H
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NH, and -SH, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the
group consisting of O, S, NH, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally
oxidized, wherein the N atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0241] In preferred embodiments, the R
37 groups not being hydrogen are not substituted. In preferred embodiments, the R
37 groups not being hydrogen do not contain heteroatoms. In some preferred embodiments,
R
37 is hydrogen.
[0242] S
P is a spacer as defined herein and C
C is a Construct-C as defined herein.
[0243] In Formula (1) two R
47 and /or R
37 are optionally comprised in a ring.
[0244] In Formula (1) two R
47 and /or R
37 are optionally comprised in a ring so as to form a ring fused to the eight-membered
trans-ring of Formula (1). It is preferred that when two R
47 and /or R
37 groups are comprised in a ring so as to form a ring fused to the eight-membered trans-ring,
that these rings fused to the eight-membered trans-ring are C
3-C
7 cycloalkylene groups and C
4-C
7 cycloalkenylene groups, optionally substituted and containing heteroatoms as described
for R
47.
Label
[0245] The compound of Formula (1) comprises a Label that is capable of providing the desired
diagnostic, imaging, and/or radiotherapeutic effect.
[0246] The Label is a moiety comprising a radionuclide.
[0247] Especially for imaging applications, it is preferred that the Label is a detectable
label. A "detectable label" as used herein relates to the part of the compound of
Formula (1) which allows detection of the compound of Formula (1) when present in
a cell, tissue or organism. One type of detectable label envisaged within the context
of the present invention is a contrast providing label. Different types of detectable
labels are envisaged within the context of the present invention and are described
hereinbelow.
[0248] Thus, according to a particular embodiment of the present invention, the compounds,
combinations, kits, and methods of the present invention are used in imaging, especially
medical imaging. In order to identify the Primary Target and/or to evaluate the biodistribution
of the compound of Formula (1), use is made of a detectable Label.
[0249] Preferred detectable labels for imaging are contrast-providing moieties used in traditional
imaging systems.
[0250] Preferably, the radionuclide comprised in a Label for imaging is an isotope selected
from the group consisting of
3H,
11C,
13N,
15O,
18F,
19F,
44Sc,
51Cr,
52Fe,
52Mn,
55Co,
60Cu,
61Cu,
62Zn,
62Cu,
63Zn,
64Cu,
66Ga,
67Ga,
68Ga,
70As,
71As,
72As,
74As,
75Se,
75Br,
76Br,
77Br,
8OBr,
82Br,
82Rb,
86Y,
88Y,
89Sr,
89Zr,
97Ru,
99mTc,
110In,
111In
113In,
114In,
117Sn,
120I
122Xe,
123I,
124I,
125I,
166Ho,
167Tm,
169Yb,
193Pt,
195Pt,
201Tl, and
203Pb.
[0251] More preferably, the radionuclide comprised in a Label for imaging is an isotope
selected from the group consisting of
18F,
44Sc,
64Cu,
68Ga,
89Zr,
99mTc,
111In,
123I, and
124I.
[0252] Other elements and isotopes, such as being used for therapy may also be applied for
imaging in certain applications.
[0253] In one embodiment the detectable labels comprise small size organic PET and SPECT
radioisotopes, such as
18F,
11C ,
123I or
124I. Due to their small size, organic PET or SPECT radioisotopes are ideally suited
for monitoring intracellular events as they do not greatly affect the properties of
the Administration Agent in general and its membrane transport in particular.
[0254] In preferred embodiments, especially when the compound of Formula (1) is used in
therapeutic applications, the Label is a therapeutic Label, said Label comprising
a radioactive isotope for radiation therapy. A radionuclide used for therapy is preferably
an isotope selected from the group consisting of
24Na,
32P,
33P,
47Sc,
59Fe,
67Cu,
76As,
77As,
80Br,
82Br,
89Sr,
90Nb,
90Y,
103Ru,
105Rh,
109Pd,
111Ag
111In
121Sn,
127Te,
131I,
140La,
141Ce,
142Pr,
143Pr,
144Pr,
149Pm,
149Tb,
151Pm,
153Sm,
159Gd,
161Tb,
165Dy,
166Dy,
166Ho,
169Er,
172Tm,
175Yb,
177Lu,
186Re,
188Re,
198Au,
199Au,
211At,
211Bi,
212Bi,
212Pb,
213Bi,
214Bi,
223Ra,
224Ra,
225Ac, and
227Th.
[0255] More preferably, the radionuclide comprised in a Label for therapy is an isotope
selected from the group consisting of
90Y,
111In,
131I,
177Lu,
186Re,
188Re,
211At,
212Pb,
213Bi
225Ac, and
227Th.
[0256] When the Label is intended to comprise a metal, such as
111In for SPECT imaging, such is preferably provided in the form of a chelate. In such
a case the Label preferably comprises a structural moiety capable of forming a coordination
complex with such a metal. A good example hereof are macrocylic lanthanide(III) chelates
derived from 1,4,7,10-tetraazacyclododecane-1,4,7,10-tetraacetic acid (H
4dota).
[0257] In preferred embodiments, the Label is selected from the group consisting of -OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, -CF
3, -SR
37, S(=O)
2N(R
37)
2, OC(=O)R
37, SC(=O) R
37, OC(=S)R
37, SC(=S)R
37, NR
37C(=O)-R
37, NR
37C(=S)-R
37, NR
37C(=O)O-R
37, NR
37C(=S)O-R
37, NR
37C(=O)S-R
37, NR
37C(=S)S-R
37, OC(=O)N(R
37)
2, SC(=O)N(R
37)
2, OC(=S)N(R
37)
2, SC(=S)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=O)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)R
37, C(=S)R
37, C(=O)N(R
37)
2, C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)O-R
37, C(=O)S-R
37, C(=S)O-R
37, C(=S)S-R
37, S(O)R
37, -S(O)
2R
37, NR
37S(O)
2R
37, -ON(R
37)
2,
-NR
37OR
37, C
1-C
24 alkyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
24 aryl groups, C
2-C
24 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
24 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkenyl groups, C
12-C
24 cycloalkynyl groups, C
3-C
24 (cyclo)alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkyl, C
4-C
24 (cyclo)alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkenyl groups, C
4-C
24 (cyclo)alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkynyl groups, C
4-C
24 alkylcycloalkyl groups, and C
4-C
24 cycloalkylalkyl groups;
the R37 groups, alkyl groups, alkenyl groups, alkynyl groups, aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl
groups, cycloalkenyl groups, cycloalkynyl groups, (cyclo)alkyl(hetero)aryl groups,
(hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkyl groups, (cyclo)alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkenyl
groups, (cyclo)alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkynyl groups, alkylcycloalkyl
groups, cycloalkylalkyl groups comprise, are substituted with, and/or chelating at
least one isotope selected from the group consisting of 3H, 11C, 13N, 15O, 18F, 19F, 51Cr, 52Fe, 52Mn, 55Co, 60Cu, 61Cu, 62Zn, 62Cu, 63Zn, 64Cu, 66Ga, 67Ga, 68Ga, 70As, 71As, 72As, 74As, 75Se, 75Br, 76Br, 77Br, 8OBr, 82Br, 82Rb, 86Y, 88Y, 90Y, 89Sr, 89Zr, 97Ru, 99mTc, 110In, 111In 113In, 114In, 117Sn, 120I, 122Xe, 123I, 124I, 125I, 166Ho, 167Tm, 169Yb, 193Pt, 195Pt, 201Tl, 203Pb, 24Na, 32P, 33P, 47Sc, 59Fe, 67Cu, 76As, 77As, 90Nb, 103Ru, 105Rh, 109Pd, 111Ag, 121Sn, 127Te, 131I, 140La, 141Ce, 142Pr, 143Pr 144Pr, 149Pm, 149Tb, 151Pm, 153Sm, 159Gd, 161Tb, 165Dy, 166Dy, 166Ho, 169Er, 172Tm, 175Yb, 177Lu, 186Re, 188Re, 198Au, 199Au, 211At, 211Bi, 212Bi, 212Pb, 213Bi, 214Bi, 223Ra, 224Ra, 225Ac and 227Th,
and are optionally further substituted with a moiety selected from the group consisting
of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OR37, -N(R37)2, -SO3R37, -PO3(R37)2, -PO4(R37)2, -NO2,-CF3, =O, =NR37, and -SR37, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of O, S, NR37, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0258] In another preferred embodiment, the Label is selected from the group consisting
of -OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, -CF
3, -SR
37, S(=O)
2N(R
37)
2, OC(=O)R
37, SC(=O)R
37, OC(=S)R
37, SC(=S)R
37, NR
37C(=O)-R
37, NR
37C(=S)-R
37, NR
37C(=O)O-R
37, NR
37C(=S)O-R
37, NR
37C(=O)S-R
37, NR
37C(=S)S-R
37, OC(=O)N(R
37)
2, SC(=O)N(R
37)
2, OC(=S)N(R
37)
2, SC(=S)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=O)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)R
37, C(=S)R
37, C(=O)N(R
37)
2, C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)O-R
37, C(=O)S-R
37, C(=S)O-R
37, C(=S)S-R
37, C
1-C
12 alkyl groups, C
2-C
12 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
12 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
12 aryl groups, C
2-C
12 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
12 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkenyl groups, C
12-C
12 cycloalkynyl groups, C
3-C
12 (cyclo)alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
12 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkyl, C
4-C
12 (cyclo)alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
12 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkenyl groups, C
4-C
12 (cyclo)alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
12 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkynyl groups, C
4-C
12 alkylcycloalkyl groups, and C
4-C
12 cycloalkylalkyl groups;
the R37 groups, alkyl groups, alkenyl groups, alkynyl groups, aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl
groups, cycloalkenyl groups, cycloalkynyl groups, (cyclo)alkyl(hetero)aryl groups,
(hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkyl groups, (cyclo)alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkenyl
groups, (cyclo)alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkynyl groups, alkylcycloalkyl
groups, cycloalkylalkyl groups comprise, are substituted with, and/or chelating at
least one isotope selected from the group consisting of 3H, 11C, 13N, 15O, 18F, 19F, 44Sc, 51Cr, 52Fe, 52Mn, 55Co, 60Cu, 61Cu, 62Zn, 62Cu, 63Zn, 64Cu, 66Ga, 67Ga, 68Ga, 70As, 71As, 72As, 74As, 75Se, 75Br, 76Br, 77Br, 8OBr, 82Br, 82Rb, 86Y, 88Y, 90Y, 89Sr, 89Zr, 97Ru, 99mTc, 110In, 111In 113In 114In, 117Sn, 120I, 122Xe, 123I 124I, 125I, 166Ho, 167Tm, 169Yb, 193Pt, 195Pt, 201Tl, 203Pb, 24Na, 32P, 33P, 47Sc, 59Fe, 67Cu, 76As, 77As, 90Nb, 103Ru, 105Rh, 109Pd, 111Ag, 121Sn, 127Te, 131I, 140La, 141Ce, 142Pr, 143Pr 144Pr, 149Pm, 149Tb, 151Pm, 153Sm, 159Gd, 161Tb, 165Dy, 166Dy, 166Ho, 169Er, 172Tm, 175Yb, 177Lu, 186Re, 188Re, 198Au, 199Au, 211At, 211Bi, 212Bi, 212Pb, 213Bi, 214Bi, 223Ra, 224Ra, 225Ac, and 227Th,
and are optionally further substituted with a moiety selected from the group consisting
of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OR37, -N(R37)2, -SO3R37, -PO3(R37)2, -PO4(R37)2, -NO2,-CF3, =O, =NR37, and -SR37, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of O, S, NR37, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0259] In preferred embodiments, each Label is independently selected from the group consisting
of -OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, -CF
3, -SR
37, S(=O)
2N(R
37)
2, OC(=O)R
37, SC(=O)R
37, OC(=S)R
37, SC(=S)R
37, NR
37C(=O)-R
37, NR
37C(=S)-R
37, NR
37C(=O)O-R
37, NR
37C(=S)O-R
37, NR
37C(=O)S-R
37, NR
37C(=S)S-R
37, OC(=O)N(R
37)
2, SC(=O)N(R
37)
2, OC(=S)N(R
37)
2, SC(=S)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=O)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)R
37, C(=S)R
37, C(=O)N(R
37)
2, C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)O-R
37, C(=O)S-R
37, C(=S)O-R
37, C(=S)S-R
37, C
1-C
6 alkyl groups, C
2-C
6 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
6 alkynyl groups, C
6 aryl groups, C
2-C
6 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
6 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
6 cycloalkenyl groups, C
8 cycloalkynyl groups, C
3-C
6 (cyclo)alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
6 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkyl, C
4-C
6 (cyclo)alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
6 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkenyl groups, C
4-C
6 (cyclo)alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
6 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkynyl groups, C
4-C
6 alkylcycloalkyl groups, and C
4-C
6 cycloalkylalkyl groups;
the R37 groups, alkyl groups, alkenyl groups, alkynyl groups, aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl
groups, cycloalkenyl groups, cycloalkynyl groups, (cyclo)alkyl(hetero)aryl groups,
(hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkyl groups, (cyclo)alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkenyl
groups, (cyclo)alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkynyl groups, alkylcycloalkyl
groups, cycloalkylalkyl groups comprise, are substituted with and/or chelating at
least one isotope selected from the group consisting of 3H, 11C, 13N, 15O, 18F, 19F, 44Sc, 51Cr, 52Fe, 52Mn, 55Co, 60Cu, 61Cu, 62Zn, 62Cu, 63Zn, 64Cu, 66Ga, 67Ga, 68Ga, 70As, 71As, 72As, 74As, 75Se, 75Br, 76Br, 77Br, 8OBr, 82Br, 82Rb, 86Y, 88Y, 90Y, 89Sr, 89Zr, 97Ru, 99mTc, 110In 111In 113In 114In, 117Sn, 120I, 122Xe, 123I 124I, 125I, 166Ho, 167Tm, 169Yb, 193Pt, 195Pt, 201Tl, 203Pb, 24Na, 32P, 33P, 47Sc, 59Fe, 67Cu, 76As, 77As, 90Nb, 103Ru, 105Rh, 109Pd, 111Ag, 121Sn, 127Te, 131I, 140La, 141Ce, 142Pr, 143Pr 144Pr, 149Pm, 149Tb, 151Pm, 153Sm, 159Gd, 161Tb, 165Dy, 166Dy, 166Ho, 169Er, 172Tm, 175Yb, 177Lu, 186Re, 188Re, 198Au, 199Au, 211At, 211Bi, 212Bi, 212Pb, 213Bi, 214Bi, 223Ra, 224Ra,225Ac, and 227Th,
and are optionally further substituted with a moiety selected from the group consisting
of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OR37, -N(R37)2, -SO3R37, -PO3(R37)2, -PO4(R37)2, -NO2,-CF3, =O, =NR37, and -SR37, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of O, S, NR37, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0260] In a preferred embodiment the Label is derived from a prosthetic group. The person
skilled in the art will understand that a prosthetic group is a precursor that can
be radiolabeled with a radionuclide like
131I thus forming the Label.
[0261] In another preferred embodiment, the Label is selected from the group consisting
of C
1-C
12 alkyl groups, C
2-C
12 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
12 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
12 aryl groups, C
2-C
12 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
12 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkenyl groups, C
12-C
12 cycloalkynyl groups, C
3-C
12 (cyclo)alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
12 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkyl, C
4-C
12 (cyclo)alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
12 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkenyl groups, C
4-C
12 (cyclo)alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
12 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkynyl groups, C
4-C
12 alkylcycloalkyl groups, and C
4-C
12 cycloalkylalkyl groups; said groups comprise, or are substituted with, at least one
isotope selected from the group consisting of
3H,
11C,
13N,
15O,
18F,
19F,
75Br,
76Br,
77Br,
8OBr,
82Br,
120I
123I
124I
125I
32P,
33P,
131I and
211At;
and are optionally further substituted with a moiety selected from the group consisting
of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, -SO
3R
37, -PO
3(R
37)
2, -PO
4(R
37)
2, -NO
2,-CF
3, =O, =NR
37, and -SR
37, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of O, S, NR
37, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0262] In a preferred embodiment the Label comprises a chelating moiety.
[0263] In a preferred embodiment, the Label is a chelating moiety selected from the group
consisting of conjugates of DTPA (diethylenetriaminepentaacetic acid), DOTA (1,4,7,10-
tetraazacyclododecane-N,N',N",N"-tetraacetic acid), DOTAGA anhydride (2,2',2"-(10-(2,6-dioxotetrahydro-2H-pyran-3-yl)-1,4,7,10-tetraazacyclododecane-1,4,7-triyl)triacetic
acid), NOTA (1,4,7-triazacyclononane-N,N',N"-triacetic acid), TETA (1,4,8,11-tetraazacyclotetradecane-N,N',N",N'-tetraacetic
acid), OTTA (N1-(
p-isothiocyanatobenzyl)-diethylenetriamine-N
1,N
2,N
3,N
3-tetraacetic acid), deferoxamine or DFO (N'-[5-[[4-[[5-(acetylhydroxyamino)pentyl]amino]-1,4-dioxobutyl]hydroxyamino]pentyl]-N-(5-aminopentyl)-N-hydroxybutanediamide),
and the DFO derivative called DFO*, and HYNIC (hydrazinonicotinamide); and the chelating
moiety chelates a metal selected from the group consisting of
44Sc,
51Cr,
52Fe,
52Mn,
55Co,
60Cu,
61Cu,
62Zn,
62Cu,
63Zn,
64Cu,
66Ga,
67Ga,
68Ga,
70As,
71As,
72As,
74As,
75Se,
82Rb,
86Y,
88Y,
89Sr,
89Zr,
97Ru,
99mTc,
110In,
111In
113In,
114In,
117Sn,
122Xe,
166Ho,
167Tm,
169Yb,
193Pt,
195Pt,
201Tl,
203Pb,
24Na,
47Sc,
59Fe,
67Cu,
76As,
77As,
89Sr,
90Nb,
90Y,
103Ru,
105Rh,
109Pd,
111Ag
111In
121Sn,
127Te,
140La,
141Ce,
142Pr,
143Pr,
144Pr,
149Pm,
149Tb,
151Pm,
153Sm,
159Gd,
161Tb,
165Dy,
166Dy,
166Ho,
169Er,
172Tm,
175Yb,
177Lu,
186Re,
188Re,
198Au,
199Au,
211At,
211Bi,
212Bi,
212Pb,
213Bi,
214Bi,
223Ra,
224Ra,
225Ac, and
227Th.
[0264] In a preferred embodiment the metal chelate comprises an acyclic derivative of ethylenediaminotetraacetic
acid (EDTA) or diethylenediaminotetraacetic acid (DTPA):

, wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to the rest of the molecule.
[0265] In another preferred embodiment the metal chelate comprises an acyclic chelator containing
carboxy-pyridine groups:

, wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to the rest of the molecule.
[0267] In another preferred embodiment the metal chelate comprises a derivative of 1,4,7-triazacyclononane
(TACN):

, wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to the rest of the molecule.
[0268] In yet another preferred embodiment the metal chelate comprises a macrocyclic chelator
containing N and O heteroatoms:

, wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to the rest of the molecule.
[0269] In another preferred embodiment the metal chelate comprises a derivative of the cryptand
agent sarcophagine (Sar):

, wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to the rest of the molecule.
[0270] In another preferred embodiment the metal chelate comprises a linear or cyclic chelator
containing hydroxamate groups:

, wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to the rest of the molecule.
[0271] In yet another preferred embodiment the metal chelate comprises a linear or cyclic
chelator containing 3-hydroxy-4-pyridinone (3,4-HOPO) groups:

, wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to the rest of the molecule.
[0272] In another preferred embodiment the metal chelate comprises a linear or cyclic chelator
containing N, S and P heteroatoms:

, wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to the rest of the molecule M denotes a radionuclide
selected from the group consisting of
99mTc,
186Re, and
188Re.
[0273] In another preferred embodiment the metal chelate comprises glycine, serine, cysteine,
lysine and alanine residues:

, wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to the rest of the molecule M denotes a radionuclide
selected from the group consisting of
99mTc,
186Re, and
188Re.
[0274] In another preferred embodiment the metal chelate contains hydrazinonicotinic acid
(HYNIC) and a co-ligand:

, wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to the rest of the molecule M denotes a radionuclide
selected from the group consisting of
99mTc,
186Re, and
188Re.
[0275] In another preferred embodiment the chelate comprises carbonyl groups and a chelator
containing N, O and S heteroatoms or a cyclopentadienyle:

, wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to the rest of the molecule M denotes a radionuclide
selected from the group consisting of
99mTc,
186Re, and
188Re.
[0276] In some preferred embodiments of the present invention the label contains
18F and can be produced by the skilled person on the basis of known synthesis routes
using known labeled synthons or prosthetic groups. Several non limiting examples of
18F-containing labels are depicted below:

, wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to the rest of the molecule.
[0277] In preferred embodiments of the present invention the label contains at least one
isotope selected from the group consisting of
123I,
124I,
125I,
131I, and
211At; and is synthesized by the skilled person on the basis of known synthesis routes
using prosthetic groups. Several preferred embodiments of such labels are depicted
below:

, wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to the rest of the molecule and X denotes
123I,
124I,
125I,
131I or
211At.
[0278] In yet another preferred embodiment of the present invention the label contains at
least one isotope selected from the group consisting of
123I,
124I,
125I,
131I, and
211At;and is synthetized by the skilled person on the basis of known synthesis routes
using a closo-decaborate(2-) group:

, wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to the rest of the molecule and X denotes
123I,
124I,
125I,
131I or
211At.
Administration Agent
[0279] The Administration Agent is an antibody. The Administration Agent can be any construct
of which it is desired to modify it with a Label for radio-imaging or radiotherapy
and of which it is desired to remove its imaging or radiotherapy label at a particular
time after injection. This particularly is the case in the event of targeted imaging
and radiotherapy to a site, such as a tumor, within the body of a subject, notably
a human subject. The sole requirement is that it can be provided with a Trigger T
R, which is further linker to a Label. The precise linkage of the Trigger to the Administration
Agent will depend on the molecular structure of both, but it should be noted that
this does not normally present a particular challenge to the person skilled in the
art, as many proven conjugation methods and linkage moieties for various biomolecules
exist. The linkage can, optionally, be via a spacer such as a polyethylene glycol
(PEG) chain.
[0280] Typically the Administration Agent can bind to a Primary Target, as defined herein.
Said Primary Target can be a target to which a Targeting Agent binds or it can be
a therapeutic target upon which a drug has its effect. In a preferred embodiment the
Primary Target is a therapeutic target and the Targeting Agent is a drug and binds
said Primary Target.
[0281] In preferred embodiments, the Administration Agent is a Targeting Agent as defined
herein, insofar the Targeting Agent is described as an antibody.
[0282] In other preferred embodiments, the Administration Agent equals a Targeting Agent,
and the Targeting Agent is radiolabeled with a therapeutic radioisotope in order to
target therapeutic radiation to tissues expressing a Primary Target.
[0283] In other preferred embodiments, the Administration Agent equals a Targeting Agent,
and the Targeting Agent is radiolabeled with a diagnostic radioisotope in order to
image tissues expressing a Primary Target.
[0284] In preferred embodiments, the Administration Agent is an antibody that comprises
an FcRn binding domain, more preferably an intact IgG antibody. Preferably, the Administration
Agent is an intact antibody.
[0285] In other preferred embodiments, the Administration Agent is an antibody that comprises
an albumin-binding moiety.
[0286] In other preferred embodiments the Administration Agent equals a drug. In other preferred
embodiments the Administration Agent equals a drug and the drug is labeled using the
presented invention for the purpose of imaging in vivo drug distribution. Drugs that
can be used in an Administration Agent relevant to this invention are pharmaceutically
active compounds which are antibodies.
[0287] In a preferred embodiment the pharmaceutically active compound or drug is selected
from the group consisting of cytotoxins, antiproliferative/antitumor agents, antiviral
agents, antibiotics, anti-inflammatory agents, chemosensitizing agents, radiosensitizing
agents, immunomodulators, immunosuppressants, immunostimulants, anti-angiogenic factors,
and enzyme inhibitors.
[0288] In other preferred embodiments the drug is designed to act in the central neural
system, for example in the context of Alzheimer's disease and Parkinsons' disease,
for example antibodies against beta-amyloid and Tau proteins.
[0289] Exemplary immunemodulators are antibodies against PD-L1, PD-1, LAG-3, OX40, TIGIT,
TIM-3, B7H4, Vista, CTLA-4, APRIL, GITR, CD3, CD28, CD40, CD74, RIG, MDA-5, NLRP1,
NLRP3, AIM2, IDO, MEK, cGAS, and CD25, NKG2A.
[0290] It will be understood that chemical modifications may also be made to the Administration
Agent in order to make reactions of that compound more convenient for purposes of
preparing conjugates of the invention.
[0291] In a preferred embodiment, the Administration Agent before conjugation to the remainder
of the compound of Formula (1) comprises at least one moiety selected from the group
consisting of -OH, -NHR', -CO
2H, -SH, -S-S-, -SCH
3-, -N
3, terminal alkynyl, terminal alkenyl, -C(O)R', C
8-C
12 (hetero)cycloalkynyl, nitrone, nitrile oxide, (imino)sydnone, isonitrille, and (oxa)norbornene,
tetrazine, wherein R' equals R
37, said moiety used for conjugation to a moiety comprising the dienophile, the Label
and R
32 so as to form the compound satisfying Formula (1), and comprising a C
M2 or C
X moiety.
[0292] In preferred embodiments the Administration Agent is bound to the remainder of the
compound of Formula (1) via a C
M2 selected from the group consisting of amine, amide, thioamide, aminooxy, carbamate,
thiocarbamate, urea, thiourea, sulfonamide, and sulfoncarbamate.
[0293] In preferred embodiments C
M2 equals R
10 as defined herein.
[0294] In a preferred embodiment, when the Administration Agent is conjugated via -SH or
-S-S-, then C
M2 is selected from the group consisting of

wherein the wiggly line denotes a bond to the remaining part of the molecule, and
wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to the Administration Agent, wherein R' equals
R
37 as defined herein.
[0295] In a preferred embodiment, when the Administration Agent is conjugated via -SCH
3- then C
M2 preferably is:

wherein the wiggly line denotes a bond to the remaining part of the molecule, and
wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to the Administration Agent.
[0296] In a preferred embodiment, when the Administration Agent is conjugated via -NR'-,
then C
M2 is selected from the group consisting of

wherein R' equals R
37 as defined herein, wherein the wiggly line denotes a bond to the remaining part of
the molecule, and wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to the Administration Agent.
[0297] In a preferred embodiment, when the Administration Agent is conjugated via -C- derived
from a moiety that was -C(O)R' or -C(O)R'-, then C
M2 is selected from the group consisting of

wherein the wiggly line denotes a bond to the remaining part of the molecule, and
wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to the Administration Agent.
[0298] In a preferred embodiment, when the Administration Agent is conjugated via -C(O)-
derived from a moiety that was -C(O)OH, then C
M2 is selected from the group consisting of

wherein R' equals R
37 as defined herein, wherein the wiggly line denotes a bond to the remaining part of
the molecule, and wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to the Administration Agent.
[0299] In a preferred embodiment, when the Administration Agent is conjugated via -O-, then
C
M2 is selected from the group consisting of

wherein R' equals R
37 as defined herein, wherein the wiggly line denotes a bond to the remaining part of
the molecule, and wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to the Administration Agent.
[0300] In a preferred embodiment, when the Administration Agent is conjugated via -N
3 that was reacted with an R
32 that comprised an alkyne group, then the resulting C
X comprises a triazole ring, wherein each C
X is independently selected from the group consisting of

wherein the wiggly line denotes a bond to the remaining part of the molecule, and
wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to the Administration Agent.
[0301] Preferably, the Administration Agent is modified with further moieties that equal
Formula (1), except that these further moieties do not comprise an Administration
Agent (as the first mentioned Administration Agent is already coupled to said moiety).
In a preferred embodiment, the Administration Agent is coupled to further moieties
as defined in this paragraph at 1 to 8 positions, more preferably from 1 to 6 positions,
even more preferably at 1 to 4 positions.
Further embodiments in relation to the compound of Formula (1)
[0302] In the compound of the invention the Administration Agent is an antibody.
[0303] In the compound of the invention the Label is a radiolabel, preferably a chelating
moiety that chelates a radioisotope.
[0304] The skilled person is familiar with the fact that the dienophile activity is not
necessarily dependent on the presence of all carbon atoms in the ring, since also
heterocyclic monoalkenylene eight-membered rings are known to possess dienophile activity.
Thus, in general, the invention is not limited to strictly
trans-cyclooctene. The person skilled in organic chemistry will be aware that other eight-membered
ring-based dienophiles exist, which comprise the same endocyclic double bond as the
trans-cyclooctene, but which may have one or more heteroatoms elsewhere in the ring. I.e.,
the invention generally pertains to eight-membered non-aromatic cyclic alkenylene
moieties, preferably a cyclooctene moiety, and more preferably a
trans-cyclooctene moiety.
[0305] Trans-cyclooctene or E-cyclooctene derivatives are very suitable as Triggers, especially
considering their high reactivity. Optionally, the
trans-cyclooctene (TCO) moiety comprises at least two exocyclic bonds fixed in substantially
the same plane, preferably as described in
WO 2012/156919A1, and/or it optionally comprises at least one substituent in the axial position, and
not the equatorial position. The person skilled in organic chemistry will understand
that the term "fixed in substantially the same plane" refers to bonding theory according
to which bonds are normally considered to be fixed in the same plane. Typical examples
of such fixations in the same plane include double bonds and strained fused rings.
E.g., the at least two exocyclic bonds can be the two bonds of a double bond to an
oxygen (i.e. C=O). The at least two exocyclic bonds can also be single bonds on two
adjacent carbon atoms, provided that these bonds together are part of a fused ring
(i.e. fused to the TCO ring) that assumes a substantially flat structure, therewith
fixing said two single bonds in substantially one and the same plane. Examples of
the latter include strained rings such as cyclopropyl and cyclobutyl. Without wishing
to be bound by theory, the inventors believe that the presence of at least two exocyclic
bonds in the same plane will result in an at least partial flattening of the TCO ring,
which can lead to higher reactivity in the IEDDA reaction. A background reference
providing further guidance is
WO 2012/153254. The at least two exocyclic bonds fixed in substantially the same plane are preferably
as described on page 16 and further of
WO 2012/156919 A1.
[0306] TCO moieties may consist of multiple isomers, also comprising the equatorial
vs. axial positioning of substituents on the TCO. In this respect, reference is made
to
Whitham et al. J. Chem. Soc. (C), 1971, 883-896, describing the synthesis and characterization of the equatorial and axial isomers
of
trans-cyclo-oct-2-en-ol, identified as (1RS, 2RS) and (1SR, 2RS), respectively. In these
isomers the OH substituent is either in the equatorial or axial position. Without
wishing to be bound by theory, the inventors believe that the presence of an axial
substituent increases the TCO ring strain resulting in higher reactivity in the IEDDA
reaction. A background reference providing further guidance is
WO 2012/049624.
[0307] Furthermore, in case of allylic substituents on the TCO in some embodiments it is
preferred that these are positioned axially and not equatorially.
[0308] It should be noted that, depending on the choice of nomenclature, the TCO dienophile
may also be denoted E-cyclooctene. With reference to the conventional nomenclature,
it will be understood that, as a result of substitution on the cyclooctene ring, depending
on the location and molecular weight of the substituent, the same cyclooctene isomer
may formally become denoted as a Z-isomer. In the present invention, any substituted
variants of the invention, whether or not formally "E" or "Z," or "cis" or "trans"
isomers, will be considered derivatives of unsubstituted
trans-cyclooctene, or unsubstituted E-cyclooctene. The terms "
trans-cyclooctene" (TCO) as well as E-cyclooctene are used interchangeably and are maintained
for all dienophiles according to the present invention, also in the event that substituents
would formally require the opposite nomenclature. I.e., the invention relates to cyclooctene
in which carbon atoms 1 and 6 as numbered below are in the E
(entgegen) or
trans position.

[0309] The dienophiles for use in the invention can be synthesized by the skilled person,
on the basis of known synthesis routes to cyclooctenes and corresponding hetero atom(s)-containing
rings. The skilled person further is aware of the wealth of cyclooctene derivatives
that can be synthesized via the ring closing metathesis reaction using Grubbs catalysts.
As mentioned above, the TCO possibly includes one or more heteroatoms in the ring.
This is as such sufficiently accessible to the skilled person [e.g.
WO2016025480], Reference is made, e.g., to the presence of a thioether in TCO: [
Cere et al. J. Org. Chem. 1980, 45, 261]. Also, e.g., an - O-SiR
2-O moiety in TCO: [
Prevost et al. J. Am. Chem. Soc. 2009, 131, 14182]. References to TCO syntheses wherein the allylic positioned leaving group (R
48) is an ether, ester, carbonate, carbamate or a thiocarbamate are: [
Versteegen et al Angew. Chem. Int. Ed. 2018, 57, 10494], and [
Steiger et al Chem Comm 2017, 53, 1378]. Exemplary TCOs include the following structures, indicated below with literature
references. Where a cyclooctene derivative is depicted as a Z-cyclooctene it is conceived
that this can be converted to the E-cyclooctene analog.

[0311] In a preferred embodiment, the compound of Formula (1) is any one of the racemic
and enantiomerically pure compounds listed below:

wherein the wiggly line indicates a bond to the remainder of the compound of Formula
(1).
[0312] Especially preferred compounds of Formula (1) are the enantiomerically pure compounds
listed below:

wherein the wiggly line indicates a bond to the remainder of the compound of Formula
(1).
[0314] In preferred embodiments, L
A not being R
48, L
B not being R
48, the Label, the Administration Agent, R
98, and/or C
C are bound to the remainder of the compound of Formula (1) via a residue of R
32, or a moiety C
M2 or C
X as defined herein, wherein preferably said residue of R
32 or a moiety C
M2 or C
X equals or is comprised in a Spacer. A person skilled in the art will understand that
"residue of R
32" means the conjugation reaction product of R
32 with another chemical group so as to form a conjugate, for example between C
C with the remainder of the compound according to Formula (1).
[0315] In preferred embodiments, L
A not being R
48, L
B not being R
48, the Label, the Administration Agent, R
98, and/or C
C are bound to the remainder of the molecule via C
M2 as defined herein, wherein preferably C
M2 equals or is comprised in a Spacer.
[0316] In yet other preferred embodiments, L
A not being R
48, L
B not being R
48, the Label, the Administration Agent, R
98, and/or C
C are bound to the remainder of the molecule via C
X as defined herein, wherein preferably C
X equals or is comprised in a Spacer.
[0317] In preferred embodiments, moiety C
X, C
M2 and the said residue of R
32 are comprised in L
A not being R
48, L
B not being R
48, the Label, the Administration Agent, R
98, and/or C
C.
CM2
[0318] In preferred embodiments, C
M2 is selected from the group consisting of amine, amide, thioamide, aminooxy, carbamate,
thiocarbamate, urea, thiourea, ether, sulfonamide, and sulfoncarbamate. In preferred
embodiments C
M2 equals R
10.
[0319] In preferred embodiments, C
M2 is:

wherein R' equals R
37 as defined herein, wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to or towards L
A not being R
48, L
B not being R
48, the Label, the Administration Agent, S
P, L
C, R
98, or C
C and the wiggly line denotes a bond to the remaining part of the dienophile. In preferred
embodiments the wiggly line denotes a bond to or towards L
A not being R
48, L
B not being R
48, the Label, the Administration Agent, S
P, L
C, R
98, or C
C and the dashed line denotes a bond to the remaining part of the dienophile.
CX
[0320] In preferred embodiments, C
X is:

wherein the dashed line denotes a bond to or towards L
A not being R
48, L
B not being R
48, the Label, the Administration Agent, S
P, L
C, R
98, or C
C and the wiggly line denotes a bond to the remaining part of the dienophile. In preferred
embodiments the wiggly line denotes a bond to or towards L
A not being R
48, L
B not being R
48, the Label, the Administration Agent, S
P, L
C, R
98, or C
C and the dashed line denotes a bond to the remaining part of the dienophile.
[0321] With reference to above schemes with examples of C
M2 and C
X, in some embodiments it is preferred that when L
A not being R
48, L
B not being R
48, the Label, the Administration Agent, R
98, or C
C is a protein, such as an antibody, that the dashed line denotes a bond to or towards
L
A not being R
48, L
B not being R
48, the Label, the Administration Agent, R
98, or C
C.
Intermediates for the preparation of compounds of Formula (1)
[0322] Preferred intermediates to prepare compounds of Formula (1) of the invention are
listed below. Particularly preferred intermediates from the below are enantiomerically
pure compounds A-F, in particular A, D, E, F. A person skilled in the art will understand
that compounds E and F still need to be isomerized to E-cyclooctenes, after which
the enantiomer with the axial OH can be separated from the enantiomer with the equatorial
OH as described by
Rossin et al Bioconj.Chem., 2016 27(7):1697-1706.

[0323] A general synthesis method of a TCO trigger and its corresponding compound of Formula
(1)s is shown directly below. The synthesis method is as reported in
Rossin et al Nature Communications 2018, 9, 1484 and
Rossin et al Bioconj.Chem., 2016 27(7):1697-1706 with the exception of the conversion of D to F, which now is conducted by mixing
D with hydroxide solution in methanol, followed by evaporation and reaction with iodomethane.
Please note that for sake of clarity only one of the two enantiomers of E-K is shown.
A person skilled in the art will understand that the enantiomers can be separated
at various stages in the synthesis using established chiral resolution methods to
obtain enantiomerically pure B, E, F, H, for example, such as chiral salts.

wherein the wiggly line denotes the bond to the remainder of R
48 and the dashed line denotes the bond to the remainder of the molecule.
Cleaving Agent
[0324] The compound used to release one or more moieties R
48 from the structure of Formula (1) is herein referred to as "Cleaving Agent".
[0325] In a preferred embodiment, the combination of the invention comprises a Cleaving
Agent with the proviso that when at least one R
48 in Formula (1) is L
B, then the Cleaving Agent does not comprise the Label of L
B; with the proviso that when at least one R
48 in Formula (1) is L
A, then the Cleaving Agent does not comprise the Administration Agent of L
A;
wherein the Cleaving Agent is a diene.
[0326] In a preferred embodiment, the Cleaving Agent does not comprise a Label.
[0327] In a preferred embodiment, the Cleaving Agent does not comprise an Administration
Agent.
[0328] In preferred embodiments wherein the Primary Target is an internalizing receptor
and it is desired to selectively cleave the Label in blood and not at the Primary
Target, the Cleaving Agent is preferentially designed to be cell impermeable. In said
embodiment, wherein the Label is a chelate then the Cleaving Agent can be either internalizing
or non-internalizing ,as the cleaved chelate cannot escape the target cell.
[0329] In preferred embodiments, wherein the Primary Target is a non internalizing receptor
and it is desired to cleave the Label in blood and not at the Primary Target, the
Cleaving Agent is preferentially designed to extravasate poorly into tissues and rapidly
clear, to minimize reaction at the Primary Target while achieving cleavage in blood.
[0330] In a preferred embodiment, the combination of the invention is a kit.
[0331] In some embodiments, preferably, the Cleaving Agent has a molecular weight of at
most 150 kDa, when at least one R
48 in Formula (1) is L
A that does not comprise a Label; more preferably at most 70 kDa, most preferably at
most 1 kDa.
[0332] In other embodiments, preferably, the Cleaving Agent has a molecular weight of at
least 300 kDa, to minimize extravasation.
[0333] In preferred embodiments the Cleaving Agent is cell-impermeable, to further increase
the selective cleavage of a compound of Formula (1) present in non-target sites (e.g.
blood).
[0334] In preferred embodiments, the properties of the Cleaving Agent (e.g. level of cell
permeability and extravasation) are achieved by a suitably chosen R
87 group (vide infra), comprised in the Clearing Agent formulas below.
[0335] Preferably, the reaction of the Cleaving Agent with the Administration Agent present
in a tissue of interest in vivo results in at least 20 % reduction of radioactivity,
more preferably at least 40 %, more preferably at least 60 %, even more preferably
at least 80 %.
[0336] In a preferred embodiment, the Cleaving Agent is a tetrazine. Tetrazines are dienes
and are highly reactive towards dienophiles, especially the TCO constructs
(vide supra)
. The diene of the Cleaving Agent is selected so as to be capable of reacting with
the dienophile, e.g. the TCO, by undergoing a Diels-Alder cycloaddition followed by
a retro Diels-Alder reaction, giving the IEDDA adduct. This intermediate adduct then
releases the Construct-A.
[0337] Synthesis routes to tetrazines in general are readily available to the skilled person,
based on standard knowledge in the art. References to tetrazine synthesis routes include
for example
Lions et al, J. Org. Chem., 1965, 30, 318-319;
Horwitz et al, J. Am. Chem. Soc., 1958, 80, 3155-3159;
Hapiot et al, New J. Chem., 2004, 28, 387-392,
Kaim et al, Z. Naturforsch., 1995, 50b, 123-127,
Yang et al., Angew. Chem. 2012, 124, 5312 -5315;
Mao et al., Angew. Chem. Int. Ed. 2019, 58, 1106-1109;
Qu et al. Angew. Chem. Int. Ed. 2018, 57, 12057 -12061;
Selvaraj et al., Tetrahedron Lett. 2014, 55, 4795-4797;
Fan et al., Angew. Chem. Int. Ed. 2016, 55, 14046-14050.
[0338] Preferably, the Cleaving Agent is a tetrazine satisfying Formula (4) and preferably
including pharmaceutically accepted salts thereof:

wherein
each moiety Q
1 and Q
2 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, -F, -Cl, -Br, -I,
-OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, -SO
3, -PO
3-, -NO
2, -CF
3, -SR
37, S(=O)
2N(R
37)
2, OC(=O)R
37, SC(=O) R
37, OC(=S)R
37, SC(=S)R
37, NR
37C(=O)-R
37, NR
37C(=S)-R
37, NR
37C(=O)O-R
37, NR
37C(=S)O-R
37, NR
37C(=O)S-R
37, NR
37C(=S)S-R
37, OC(=O)N(R
37)
2, SC(=O)N(R
37)
2, OC(=S)N(R
37)
2, SC(=S)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=O)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)R
37, C(=S)R
37, C(=O)N(R
37)
2, C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)O-R
37, C(=O)S-R
37, C(=S)O-R
37, C(=S)S-R
37, S(O)R
37, - S(O)
2R
37, NR
37S(O)
2R
37, -ON(R
37)
2,
-NR
37OR
37, alkyl groups, alkenyl groups, alkynyl groups, aryl groups, heteroaryl groups, cycloalkyl
groups, cycloalkenyl groups, cycloalkynyl groups, (cyclo)alkyl(hetero)aryl groups,
(hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkyl, (cyclo)alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkenyl
groups, (cyclo)alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkynyl groups, alkylcycloalkyl
groups, and cycloalkylalkyl groups.
[0339] In Formula (4), the Q
1 and Q
2 groups not being H, -F, -Cl, -Br, -I, -OH, - NH
2, -SO
3, -PO
3-, -NO
2, -CF
3, are optionally substituted, preferably with a moiety selected from the group consisting
of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, -SO
3R
37, - PO
3(R
37)
2, -PO
4(R
37)
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NR
37, and -SR
37, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of O, S, NR
37, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0340] In Formula (4), the Q
1 and Q
2 groups are optionally bound to a polymer, a particle, a peptide, a peptoid, a dendrimer,
a protein, an aptamer, a carbohydrate, an oligonucleotide, an oligosaccharide, a lipid,
a steroid, a liposome, a micelle, a Targeting Agent T
T, a -(S
P)
D-R
87, an albumin-binding moiety, and a chelating moiety; wherein D is 0 or 1.
[0341] In Formula (4), preferably, at least one of moieties Q
1 and Q
2 is not hydrogen.
[0342] In Formula (4), preferably each moiety Q
1 and Q
2 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, -F, -Cl, -Br, -I,
-OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, -SO
3, -PO
3-, -NO
2, -CF
3, -SR
37, S(=O)
2N(R
37)
2, OC(=O)R
37, SC(=O) R
37, OC(=S)R
37, SC(=S)R
37, NR
37C(=O)-R
37, NR
37C(=S)-R
37, NR
37C(=O)O-R
37, NR
37C(=S)O-R
37, NR
37C(=O)S-R
37, NR
37C(=S)S-R
37, OC(=O)N(R
37)
2, SC(=O)N(R
37)
2, OC(=S)N(R
37)
2, SC(=S)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=O)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)R
37, C(=S)R
37, C(=O)N(R
37)
2, C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)O-R
37, C(=O)S-R
37, C(=S)O-R
37, C(=S)S-R
37, S(O)R
37, -S(O)
2R
37, NR
37S(O)
2R
37, -ON(R
37)
2,
-NR
37OR
37, C
1-C
24 alkyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
24 aryl groups, C
2-C
24 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
24 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkenyl groups, C
12-C
24 cycloalkynyl groups, C
3-C
24 (cyclo)alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkyl, C
4-C
24 (cyclo)alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkenyl groups, C
4-C
24 (cyclo)alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkynyl groups, C
4-C
24 alkylcycloalkyl groups, and C
4-C
24 cycloalkylalkyl groups.
[0343] In preferred embodiments, the Q
1 and Q
2 groups not being hydrogen are not substituted.
[0344] In a preferred embodiment, Q
1 and Q
2 in Formula (4) are selected from the group of hydrogen, -F, -Cl, -Br, -I, -OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, -SO
3, -PO
3-, -NO
2, -CF
3, -SR
37, S(=O)
2N(R
37)
2, OC(=O)R
37, SC(=O) R
37, OC(=S)R
37, SC(=S)R
37, NR
37C(=O)-R
37, NR
37C(=S)-R
37, NR
37C(=O)O-R
37, NR
37C(=S)O-R
37, NR
37C(=O)S-R
37, NR
37C(=S)S-R
37, OC(=O)N(R
37)
2, SC(=O)N(R
37)
2, OC(=S)N(R
37)
2, SC(=S)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=O)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)R
37, C(=S)R
37, C(=O)N(R
37)
2, C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)O-R
37, C(=O)S-R
37, C(=S)O-R
37, C(=S)S-R
37, S(O)R
37, - S(O)
2R
37, NR
37S(O)
2R
37, -ON(R
37)
2,
-NR
37OR
37, C
1-C
8 alkyl groups, C
2-C
8 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
8 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
12 aryl groups, C
2-C
12 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
8 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
8 cycloalkenyl groups, C
3-C
12 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
12 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups and C
5-C
12 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups.
[0345] In a preferred embodiment, Q
1 and Q
2 in Formula (4) are selected from the group of hydrogen, -F, -Cl, -Br, -I, -OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, -SO
3, -PO
3-, -NO
2, -CF
3, -SR
37, S(=O)
2N(R
37)
2, OC(=O)R
37, SC(=O) R
37, OC(=S)R
37, SC(=S)R
37, NR
37C(=O)-R
37, NR
37C(=S)-R
37, NR
37C(=O)O-R
37, NR
37C(=S)O-R
37, NR
37C(=O)S-R
37, NR
37C(=S)S-R
37, OC(=O)N(R
37)
2, SC(=O)N(R
37)
2, OC(=S)N(R
37)
2, SC(=S)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=O)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)R
37, C(=S)R
37, C(=O)N(R
37)
2, C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)O-R
37, C(=O)S-R
37, C(=S)O-R
37, C(=S)S-R
37, S(O)R
37, - S(O)
2R
37, NR
37S(O)
2R
37, -ON(R
37)
2,
-NR
37OR
37, C
1-C
4 alkyl groups, C
2-C
4 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
4 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
8 aryl groups, C
2-C
8 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
6 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
6 cycloalkenyl groups, C
3-C
10 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
10 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
10 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
4-C
10 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
5-C
10 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups and C
5-C
10 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups.
[0346] In a preferred embodiment, Q
1 and Q
2 in Formula (4) are selected from the group of hydrogen, phenyl, 2-pyridyl, 3-pyridyl,
4-pyridyl, 2,6-pyrimidyl, 2,5-pyrimidyl, 3,5-pyrmidyl, and 2,4-pyrimidyl; and Q
1 and Q
2 not being hydrogen are optionally substituted with a moiety selected from the group
consisting of -F, -Cl, -Br, -I, -OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, -SO
3, -PO
3-, -NO
2, -CF
3, -SR
37, S(=O)
2N(R
37)
2, OC(=O)R
37, SC(=O) R
37, OC(=S)R
37, SC(=S)R
37, NR
37C(=O)-R
37, NR
37C(=S)-R
37, NR
37C(=O)O-R
37, NR
37C(=S)O-R
37, NR
37C(=O)S-R
37, NR
37C(=S)S-R
37, OC(=O)N(R
37)
2, SC(=O)N(R
37)
2, OC(=S)N(R
37)
2, SC(=S)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=O)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)R
37, C(=S)R
37, C(=O)N(R
37)
2, C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)O-R
37, C(=O)S-R
37, C(=S)O-R
37, C(=S)S-R
37, S(O)R
37, -S(O)
2R
37, NR
37S(O)
2R
37, -ON(R
37)
2, -NR
37OR
37, C
1-C
24 alkyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
24 aryl groups, C
2-C
24 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
24 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkenyl groups, C
12-C
24 cycloalkynyl groups, C
3-C
24 (cyclo)alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkyl, C
4-C
24 (cyclo)alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkenyl groups, C
4-C
24 (cyclo)alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
24 (hetero)aryl(cyclo)alkynyl groups, C
4-C
24 alkylcycloalkyl groups, and C
4-C
24 cycloalkylalkyl groups; preferably with a moiety selected from the group consisting
of -F, -Cl, -Br, -I, -OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, -SO
3, -PO
3-, -NO
2, -CF
3, -SR
37, S(=O)
2N(R
37)
2, OC(=O)R
37, SC(=O) R
37, OC(=S)R
37, SC(=S)R
37, NR
37C(=O)-R
37, NR
37C(=S)-R
37, NR
37C(=O)O-R
37, NR
37C(=S)O-R
37, NR
37C(=O)S-R
37, NR
37C(=S)S-R
37, OC(=O)N(R
37)
2, SC(=O)N(R
37)
2, OC(=S)N(R
37)
2, SC(=S)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=O)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)R
37, C(=S)R
37, C(=O)N(R
37)
2, C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)O-R
37, C(=O)S-R
37, C(=S)O-R
37, C(=S)S-R
37, S(O)R
37, - S(O)
2R
37, NR
37S(O)
2R
37, -ON(R
37)
2,
-NR
37OR
37, C
1-C
8 alkyl groups, C
2-C
8 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
8 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
12 aryl groups, C
2-C
12 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
8 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
8 cycloalkenyl groups, C
3-C
12 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
12 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups, and C
5-C
12 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups; more preferably with a moiety selected from the group
consisting of -F, - Cl, -Br, -I, -OR
37, -N(R
37)
2, -SO
3, -PO
3-, -NO
2, -CF
3, -SR
37, S(=O)
2N(R
37)
2, OC(=O)R
37, SC(=O) R
37, OC(=S)R
37, SC(=S)R
37, NR
37C(=O)-R
37, NR
37C(=S)-R
37, NR
37C(=O)O-R
37, NR
37C(=S)O-R
37, NR
37C(=O)S-R
37, NR
37C(=S)S-R
37, OC(=O)N(R
37)
2, SC(=O)N(R
37)
2, OC(=S)N(R
37)
2, SC(=S)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=O)N(R
37)
2, NR
37C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)R
37, C(=S)R
37, C(=O)N(R
37)
2, C(=S)N(R
37)
2, C(=O)O-R
37, C(=O)S-R
37, C(=S)O-R
37, C(=S)S-R
37, S(O)R
37, -S(O)
2R
37, NR
37S(O)
2R
37, -ON(R
37)
2,. NR
37OR
37, C
1-C
4 alkyl groups, C
2-C
4 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
4 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
8 aryl groups, C
2-C
8 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
6 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
6 cycloalkenyl groups, C
3-C
10 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
10 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
10 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
4-C
10 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
5-C
10 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups, and C
5-C
10 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups.
[0347] In a preferred embodiment, in Formula (4):
- (a) Q1 and Q2 are selected from the group consisting of 2-pyridyl, 3-pyridyl, and 4-pyridyl;
- (b) Q1 is selected from the group consisting of 2,6-pyrimidyl, 2,5-pyrimidyl, 3,5-pyrmidyl,
and 2,4-pyrimidyl; and Q2 is (hetero)alkyl; or
- (c) Q1 is phenyl and Q2 is hydrogen;
- (d) Q1 is alkyl and Q2 is alkyl;
- (e) Q1 is phenyl and Q2 is alkyl;
- (f) Q1 is phenyl and Q2 is phenyl;
and in (a)-(f) all Q
1 and Q
2 not being hydrogen are optionally substituted as defined in the previous paragraph.
[0348] In a preferred embodiment, in Formula (4) the alkyl is a C
1-C
24 alkyl group, preferably a C
1-C
12 alkyl group, more preferably a C
1-C
6 (hetero)alkyl group.
[0349] In a preferred embodiment, in Formula (4) the (hetero)aryl is a C
6-C
24 aryl group, preferably a C
6-C
12 aryl, more preferably a phenyl.
[0350] In a preferred embodiment, in Formula (4) the (hetero)aryl is a C
2-C
24 heteroaryl, preferably a C
2-C
12 heteroaryl, more preferably a C
2-C
5 heteroaryl.
[0351] In a preferred embodiment, in Formula (4) the alkenyl is a C
2-C
24 alkenyl, preferably a C
2-C
12 alkenyl, more preferably a C
2-C
6 alkenyl.
[0352] In a preferred embodiment, in Formula (4) the alkynyl is a C
2-C
24 alkynyl, preferably a C
2-C
12 alkynyl, more preferably a C
2-C
6 alkynyl.
[0353] In a preferred embodiment, in Formula (4) the cycloalkyl is a C
3-C
24 cycloalkyl, preferably a C
3-C
12 cycloalkyl, more preferably a C
3-C
6 cycloalkyl.
[0354] In a preferred embodiment, in Formula (4) the cycloalkenyl, C
5-C
24 cycloalkenyl groups, preferably a C
5-C
12 cycloalkenyl, more preferably a C
5-C
6 cycloalkenyl.
[0355] In a preferred embodiment, in Formula (4) the cycloalkynyl is a C
6-C
24 cycloalkynyl, preferably a C
8-C
12 cycloalkynyl, more preferably a C
8 cycloalkyl.
[0356] In preferred embodiments, the Cleaving Agent can be a multimeric compound, comprising
a plurality of dienes as defined herein. These multimeric compounds include but are
not limited to biomolecules, proteins, peptides, peptoids, polymers, dendrimers, liposomes,
micelles, particles, gels, polymer particles, or other polymeric constructs.
Preferred tetrazines
Formula (4a)
[0357] Preferred tetrazines are in accordance with Formula (4a), and preferably include
pharmaceutically accepted salts thereof:

, wherein each moiety Q
1 and Q
2 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and moieties according
to Formula (5):

, wherein the dashed line indicates a bond to the remainder of the molecule, and wherein
R
10, R
11, and R
12 are as defined herein.
[0358] As will be understood herein, in relation to Formula (5), the dashed line may indicate
a bond to a tetrazine group of Formula (4a), another moiety according to Formula (5),
or to the remainder of the compound according to Formulae (6)-(13) as defined below.
[0359] In a preferred embodiment, each f in Formula (5) is an integer independently selected
from a range of from 0 to 24, preferably in a range of from 1 to 12, more preferably
in a range of from 2 to 6, even more preferably from 1 to 3. In a preferred embodiment,
f is 1. In other preferred embodiments f is an integer in the range from 12 to 24.
[0360] In a preferred embodiment, in Formula (5) g is an integer in a range of from 0 to
12, preferably in a range of from 1 to 6, more preferably in a range of from 2 to
4.
[0361] In a preferred embodiment, in Formula (5) each h is independently 0 or 1. In a preferred
embodiment, g is 0, and f is 1. In a preferred embodiment, g is 1, and f is 1.
[0362] In case the compound according to the invention comprises more than one moiety satisfying
Formula (5), each g, h, and f is independently selected. In a preferred embodiment,
the moiety according to Formula (5) is optionally substituted with another independently
selected moiety according to Formula (5). In another preferred embodiment, the moiety
according to Formula (5) is not substituted with another independently selected moiety
according to Formula (5). In a preferred embodiment, the moiety according to Formula
(5) is a R
87, as defined further below.
[0363] In a preferred embodiment, the moiety according to Formula (5) satisfies molecules
from Group R
M shown further below
[0364] It is preferred that at least one of moieties Q
1 and Q
2 in Formula (4a) is not hydrogen.
[0365] In preferred embodiments, Q
1 in Formula (4a) is selected from the group consisting of C
6-C
24 aryl, and C
2-C
24 heteroaryl, and is optionally further substituted with a moiety according to Formula
(5), preferably not more than one moiety according to Formula (5).
[0366] In preferred embodiments, Q
1 in Formula (4a) is selected from the group consisting of C
6-C
24 aryl, and C
2-C
24 heteroaryl, and is optionally further substituted with a moiety according to Formula
(5), preferably not more than one moiety according to Formula (5), and Q
2 in Formula (4a) is selected from the group consisting of C
6-C
24 aryl, and C
2-C
24 heteroaryl, and is optionally further substituted with a moiety according to Formula
(5), preferably not more than one moiety according to Formula (5).
[0367] In preferred embodiments, Q
1 in Formula (4a) is selected from the group consisting of C
6 aryl, and C
3-C
5 heteroaryl, and is optionally further substituted with at least one moiety according
to Formula (5), preferably not more than one moiety according to Formula (5). Herein,
preferred heteroaryls are 2-pyridyl, 3-pyridyl, 4-pyridyl, 2,6-pyrimidyl, 3,5-pyrimidyl,
2,5-pyrimidyl, 2,4-pyrimidyl, 2,4 imidazyl, 2,5 imidazyl, phenyl, 2,3-pyrazyl, 3,4-pyrazyl,
oxazol, isoxazol, thiazol, oxazoline, 2-pyrryl, 3-pyrryl, 2-thiophene, and 3-thiophene.
[0368] In preferred embodiments, Q
1 in Formula (4a) is C
3-C
5 heteroaryl, and is optionally further substituted with at least one moiety according
to Formula (5), preferably not more than one moiety according to Formula (5), and
Q
2 is C
3-C
5 heteroaryl, and is optionally further substituted with a moiety according to Formula
(5), preferably not more than one moiety according to Formula (5). Herein, preferred
heteroaryls are 2-pyridyl, 3-pyridyl, 4-pyridyl, 2,6-pyrimidyl, 3,5-pyrimidyl, 2,5-pyrimidyl,
2,4-pyrimidyl, 2,4 imidazyl, 2,5 imidazyl, phenyl, 2,3-pyrazyl, 3,4-pyrazyl, oxazol,
isoxazol, thiazol, oxazoline, 2-pyrryl, 3-pyrryl, 2-thiophene, and 3-thiophene.
[0369] In preferred embodiments, Q
1 in Formula (4a) is C
3-C
5 heteroaryl, and is optionally further substituted with at least one moiety according
to Formula (5), preferably not more than one moiety according to Formula (5), and
Q
2 is H.
[0370] In preferred embodiments, Q
1 in Formula (4a) is a phenyl ring, and is optionally further substituted with at least
one moiety according to Formula (5), preferably not more than one moiety according
to Formula (5), and Q
2 is -H.
[0371] In preferred embodiments, Q
1 in Formula (4a) is a phenyl ring, and is optionally further substituted with at least
one moiety according to Formula (5), preferably not more than one moiety according
to Formula (5), and Q
2 is a phenyl ring, and is optionally further substituted with at least one moiety
according to Formula (5), preferably not more than one moiety according to Formula
(5).
[0372] In preferred embodiments, Q
1 in Formula (4a) is a phenyl ring, and is optionally further substituted with at least
one moiety according to Formula (5), preferably not more than one moiety according
to Formula (5), and Q
2 is selected from the group consisting of C
6 aryl, and C
3-5 heteroaryl, and is optionally further substituted with at least one moiety according
to Formula (5), preferably not more than one moiety according to Formula (5).
[0373] In preferred embodiments, Q
1 in Formula (4a) is C
1-C
12 alkyl, and is optionally further substituted with at least one moiety according to
Formula (5), preferably not more than one moiety according to Formula (5), and Q
2 selected from the group consisting of C
6 aryl, and C
3-5 heteroaryl, and is optionally further substituted with at least one moiety according
to Formula (5), preferably not more than one moiety according to Formula (5).
[0374] In preferred embodiments, Q
1 in Formula (4a) is C
1-C
12 alkyl, and is optionally further substituted with at least one moiety according to
Formula (5), preferably not more than one moiety according to Formula (5), and Q
2 in Formula (4a) is C
1-C
12 alkyl, and is optionally further substituted with at least one moiety according to
Formula (5), preferably not more than one moiety according to Formula (5).
[0375] In preferred embodiments Q
2 equals Q
1.
R10
[0376] In preferred embodiments, each R
10 is independently selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S-, -SS-, -NR
4-, -N=N-, -C(O)-, -C(O)NR
4-, -OC(O)-, -C(O)O-, -OC(O)O-, -OC(O)NR
4-, -NR
4C(O)-, -NR
4C(O)O-, -NR
4C(O)NR
4-, -SC(O)-, -C(O)S-, -SC(O)O-, -OC(O)S-, -SC(O)NR
4-, -NR
4C(O)S-, -S(O)-, -S(O)
2-, -OS(O)
2-, -S(O
2)O-, -OS(O)
2O-, -OS(O)
2NR
4-, -NR
4S(O)
2O-, -C(O)NR
4S(O)
2NR
4-, -OC(O)NR
4S(O)
2NR
4-, -OS(O)-, -OS(O)O-, -OS(O)NR
4-, -ONR
4C(O)-, -ONR
4C(O)O-, -ONR
4C(O)NR
4-, -NR
4OC(O)-, -NR
4OC(O)O-, -NR
4OC(O)NR
4-, -ONR
4C(S)-, -ONR
4C(S)O-, -ONR
4C(S)NR
4-, -NR
4OC(S)-, -NR
4OC(S)O-, -NR
4OC(S)NR
4-, -OC(S)-, -C(S)O-, -OC(S)O-, -OC(S)NR
4-, -NR
4C(S)-, -NR
4C(S)O-, -SS(O)
2-, -S(O)
2S-, -OS(O
2)S-, -SS(O)
2O-, -NR
4OS(O)-, -NR
4OS(O)O-, -NR
4OS(O)NR
4-, -NR
4OS(O)
2-, -NR
4OS(O)
2O-, -NR
4OS(O)
2NR
4-, -ONR
4S(O)-, -ONR
4S(O)O-, -ONR
4S(O)NR
4-, -ONR
4S(O)
2O-, -ONR
4S(O)
2NR
4-, -ONR
4S(O)
2-, -OP(O)(R
4)
2-, -SP(O)(R
4)
2-, -NR
4P(O)(R
4)
2-, and combinations thereof, wherein R
4 is defined as described herein.
[0377] In preferred embodiments, each R
10 is independently selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S-, -SS-, -NR
4-, -N=N-, -C(O)-, -C(O)NR
4-, -OC(O)-, - C(O)O-, -OC(O)NR
4-, -NR
4C(O)-, -NR
4C(O)O-, -NR
4C(O)NR
4-, -SC(O)-, -C(O)S-, - SC(O)O-, -OC(O)S-, -SC(O)NR
4-, -NR
4C(O)S-, -S(O)-, -S(O)
2-, -C(O)NR
4S(O)
2NR
4-, -OC(O)NR
4S(O)
2NR
4-, -OC(S)-, -C(S)O-, -OC(S)O-, -OC(S)NR
4-, -NR
4C(S)-, - NR
4C(S)O-, and -SS(O)
2-.
R11
[0378] In preferred embodiments, each R
11 is independently selected from the group consisting of C
1-C
24 alkylene groups, C
2-C
24 alkenylene groups, C
2-C
24 alkynylene groups, C
6-C
24 arylene, C
2-C
24 heteroarylene, C
3-C
24 cycloalkylene groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkenylene groups, and C
12-C
24 cycloalkynylene groups, which are optionally further substituted with one or more
substituents selected from the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NR
36, -SR
36, C
1-C
24 alkyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
24 aryl groups, C
2-C
24 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
24 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkenyl groups, C
12-C
24 cycloalkynyl groups, C
3-C
24 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
24 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
24 (hetero)arylalkenyl groups, C
4-C
24 (hetero)arylalkynyl groups, C
4-C
24 alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
24 alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
24 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
6-C
24 alkylcycloalkenyl groups, C
13-C
24 alkylcycloalkynyl groups, C
4-C
24 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
6-C
24 cycloalkenylalkyl groups, C
13-C
24 cycloalkynylalkyl groups, C
5-C
24 alkenylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
24 alkenylcycloalkenyl groups, C
14-C
24 alkenylcycloalkynyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkylalkenyl groups, C
7-C
24 cycloalkenylalkenyl groups, C
14-C
24 cycloalkynylalkenyl groups, C
5-C
24 alkynylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
24 alkynylcycloalkenyl groups, C
14-C
24 alkynylcycloalkynyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkylalkynyl groups, C
7-C
24 cycloalkenylalkynyl groups, C
14-C
24 cycloalkynylalkynyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
7-C
24 cycloalkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
14-C
24 cycloalkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
5-C
24 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
24 (hetero)arylcycloalkenyl groups, and C
14-C
24 (hetero)arylcycloalkynyl groups, wherein the substituents optionally contain one
or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of O, S, NR
36, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized; and wherein preferably the alkylene groups, alkenylene
groups, alkynylene groups, cycloalkylene groups, cycloalkenylene groups, and cycloalkynylene
groups optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of O, S, NR
36, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0379] In preferred embodiments, each R
11 is independently selected from the group consisting of C
1-C
12 alkylene groups, C
2-C
12 alkenylene groups, C
2-C
12 alkynylene groups, C
6-C
12 arylene, C
2-C
12 heteroarylene, C
3-C
12 cycloalkylene groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkenylene groups, and C
12 cycloalkynylene groups; and wherein preferably the alkylene groups, alkenylene groups,
alkynylene groups, cycloalkylene groups, cycloalkenylene groups, and cycloalkynylene
groups optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of O, S, NR
36, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0380] In preferred embodiments, each R
11 is independently selected from the group consisting of C
1-C
6 alkylene groups, C
2-C
6 alkenylene groups, C
2-C
6 alkynylene groups, C
6-C
6 arylene, C
2-C
6 heteroarylene, C
3-C
6 cycloalkylene groups, and C
5-C
6 cycloalkenylene groups;
and wherein preferably the alkylene groups, alkenylene groups, alkynylene groups,
cycloalkylene groups, cycloalkenylene groups, and cycloalkynylene groups optionally
contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of O, S, NR
36, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0381] In preferred embodiments, the R
11 groups are optionally further substituted with one or more substituents selected
from the group consisting of - Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NR
36, -SR
36, C
1-C
12 alkyl groups, C
2-C
12 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
12 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
12 aryl groups, C
2-C
12 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
12 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkenyl groups, C
12 cycloalkynyl groups, C
3-C
12 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
12 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 (hetero)arylalkenyl groups, C
4-C
12 (hetero)arylalkynyl groups, C
4-C
12 alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
12 alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
12 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
6-C
12 alkylcycloalkenyl groups, C
13-C
18 alkylcycloalkynyl groups, C
4-C
12 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
6-C
12 cycloalkenylalkyl groups, C
13-C
18 cycloalkynylalkyl groups, C
5-C
12 alkenylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
12 alkenylcycloalkenyl groups, C
14-C
16 alkenylcycloalkynyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkylalkenyl groups, C
7-C
12 cycloalkenylalkenyl groups, C
14-C
16 cycloalkynylalkenyl groups, C
5-C
12 alkynylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
12 alkynylcycloalkenyl groups, C
14-C
16 alkynylcycloalkynyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkylalkynyl groups, C
7-C
12 cycloalkenylalkynyl groups, C
14-C
16 cycloalkynylalkynyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
7-C
12 cycloalkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
14-C
16 cycloalkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
5-C
12 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
12 (hetero)arylcycloalkenyl groups, and C
14-C
16 (hetero)arylcycloalkynyl groups, wherein the substituents optionally contain one
or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of O, S, NR
36, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0382] In preferred embodiments, the R
11 groups are optionally further substituted with one or more substituents selected
from the group consisting of - Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NR
36, -SR
36, C
1-C
6 alkyl groups, C
2-C
6 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
6 alkynyl groups, C
6 aryl groups, C
2-C
6 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
6 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
6 cycloalkenyl groups, C
3-C
6 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
6 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
6 (hetero)arylalkenyl groups, C
4-C
6 (hetero)arylalkynyl groups, C
4-C
6 alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
6 alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
6 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
6 alkylcycloalkenyl groups, C
4-C
6 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
6 cycloalkenylalkyl groups, C
5-C
6 alkenylcycloalkyl groups, C
7 alkenylcycloalkenyl groups, C
5-C
6 cycloalkylalkenyl groups, C
7 cycloalkenylalkenyl groups, C
5-C
6 alkynylcycloalkyl groups, C
7 alkynylcycloalkenyl groups, C
5-C
6 cycloalkylalkynyl groups, C
5-C
6 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups, and C
5-C
6 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, wherein the substituents optionally contain one or
more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of O, S, NR
36, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0383] In preferred embodiments, the R
11 groups are optionally further substituted with one or more substituents selected
from the group consisting of - Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NR
36, -SR
36, C
1-C
6 alkyl groups, C
2-C
6 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
6 alkynyl groups, C
6 aryl groups, C
2-C
6 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
6 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
6 cycloalkenyl groups, C
3-C
7 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
7 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
8 (hetero)arylalkenyl groups, C
4-C
8 (hetero)arylalkynyl groups, C
4-C
8 alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
8 alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
6 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
6-C
7 alkylcycloalkenyl groups, C
4-C
6 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
6-C
7 cycloalkenylalkyl groups, C
5-C
6 alkenylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
8 alkenylcycloalkenyl groups, C
5-C
6 cycloalkylalkenyl groups, C
7-C
8 cycloalkenylalkenyl groups, C
5-C
6 alkynylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
8 alkynylcycloalkenyl groups, C
5-C
6 cycloalkylalkynyl groups, C
5-C
9 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups, and C
5-C
6 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, wherein the substituents optionally contain one or
more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of O, S, NR
36, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0384] It is preferred that when f > 2, that R
11 is independently selected from the group consisting of C
1-C
6 alkylene groups, C
2-C
6 alkenylene groups, C
2-C
6 alkynylene groups, C
6-C
6 arylene, C
2-C
6 heteroarylene, C
3-C
6 cycloalkylene groups, and C
5-C
6 cycloalkenylene groups; and wherein preferably the alkylene groups, alkenylene groups,
alkynylene groups, cycloalkylene groups, cycloalkenylene groups, and cycloalkynylene
groups optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of O, S, NR
36, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0385] In a preferred embodiment, the R
11 substituents do not contain heteroatoms.
[0386] In a preferred embodiment, the R
11 groups are not substituted.
[0387] In another preferred embodiment, the R
11 groups do not contain heteroatoms.
R12
[0388] R
12 is selected from the group consisting of -H, -OH, -NH
2, -N
3, -Cl, -Br, -F, -I, a polymer, a particle, a peptide, a peptoid, a dendrimer, a protein,
a biomolecule, a carbohydrate, an oligonucleotide, an oligosaccharide, a lipid, a
liposome, a micelle, an imaging moiety, a Targeting Agent T
T, a R
87, an albumin-binding moiety, and a chelating moiety.
[0389] Non-limiting examples of chelating moieties for use in R
12 are
DTPA (diethylenetriaminepentaacetic acid),
DOTA (1,4,7,10- tetraazacyclododecane-N,N',N",N"-tetraacetic acid),
NOTA (1,4,7-triazacyclononane-N,N',N"-triacetic acid),
TETA (1,4,8,11-tetraazacyclotetradecane-N,N',N",N'-tetraacetic acid),
OTTA (N1-(p-isothiocyanatobenzyl)-diethylenetriamine-N1,N2,N3,N3-tetraacetic acid), deferoxamine or DFO (N'-[5-[[4-[[5-(acetylhydroxyamino)pentyl]amino]-1,4-dioxobutyl]hydroxyamino]pentyl]-N-(5-aminopentyl)-N-hydroxybutanediamide)
or HYNIC (hydrazinonicotinamide).
[0390] In a preferred embodiment, when R
12 is a polymer, a particle, a peptide, a peptoid, a dendrimer, a protein, a biomolecule,
an oligonucleotide, an oligosaccharide, a lipid, a liposome, a micelle, a Targeting
Agent T
T, or a R
87, then f is at most 2, preferably at most 1.
Formulae (6), (7), (8), (9), (10), (11), (12), and (13)
[0391] In preferred embodiments of the invention the tetrazine is in accordance with any
one of the Formulae (6), (7), (8), (9), (10), (11), (12), or (13):

wherein each moiety Q, Q
1, Q
2, Q
3, and Q
4 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and moieties according
to Formula (5) as defined herein; and wherein R
1, R
2, and R
3 are as defined herein.
[0392] In preferred embodiments, in the tetrazines according to any one of Formulae (6),
(7), (8), (9), (10), (11), (12), and (13), at most one moiety selected from the group
consisting of Q, Q
1, Q
2, Q
3, and Q
4 is hydrogen.
[0393] In preferred embodiments, in the tetrazines according to any one of Formulae (7),
(8), (9), (10), (11), (12), and (13), at most two moieties selected from the group
consisting of Q, Q
1, Q
2, Q
3, and Q
4 are hydrogen.
[0394] In preferred embodiments, in the tetrazines according to any one of Formulae (7),
(8), (9), (10), (11), (12), and (13), at most three moieties selected from the group
consisting of Q, Q
1, Q
2, Q
3, and Q
4 are hydrogen.
[0395] In preferred embodiments, in the tetrazines according to any one of Formulae (7),
(8), (9), (10), (11), (12), and (13), all moieties selected from the group consisting
of Q,
Q 1, Q
2, Q
3, and Q
4 are hydrogen.
[0396] In preferred embodiments, in the tetrazines according to any one of Formulae (7),
(8), (9), (10), (11), (12), and (13), at most one moiety selected from the group consisting
of Q, Q
1, Q
2, Q
3, and Q
4 is not hydrogen.
[0397] In preferred embodiments, in the tetrazines according to any one of Formulae (7),
(8), (9), (10), (11), (12), and (13), at most two moieties selected from the group
consisting of Q, Q
1, Q
2, Q
3, and Q
4 is not hydrogen.
Molecular weight
[0398] Preferably, for all compounds disclosed herein comprising a group Q, Q
1, Q
2, Q
3, Q
4 or -(CH
2)
y-((R
1)
p-R
2)
n-(R
1)
p-R
3, at least one of these groups has a molecular weight in a range of from 100 Da to
3000 Da. Preferably, at least one of these groups has a molecular weight in a range
of from 100 Da to 2000 Da. More preferably, at least one of these groups has a molecular
weight in a range of from 100 Da to 1500 Da, even more preferably in a range of from
150 Da to 1500 Da. Even more preferably still, at least one of these groups has a
molecular weight in a range of from 150 Da to 1000 Da, most preferably in a range
of from 200 Da to 1000 Da.
[0399] Preferably, for all compounds disclosed herein, comprising a group Q, Q1, Q2, Q3,
Q4 or -(CH
2)
y-((R
1)
p-R
2)
n-(R
1)
p-R
3, none of these groups has a molecular weight of more than 3000 Da, in particular
in the case the Clearing Agent needs to efficiently extravasate into tissues.
Group -(CH2)y-((R1)p-R2)n-(R1)p-R3
[0400] In preferred embodiments, y is an integer in a range of from 1 to 12, preferably
from 1 to 10, more preferably from 1 to 8, even more preferably from 2 to 6, most
preferably from 2 to 4. In preferred embodiments, y is at least 2, preferably y is
at least 3. In preferred embodiments, p is 0 or 1, wherein each p is independently
selected. In preferred embodiments, each n is an integer independently selected from
a range of from 0 to 24, preferably from 1 to 12, more preferably from 1 to 6, even
more preferably from 1 to 3, most preferably n is 0 or 1. In preferred embodiments
n is preferably an integer from 12 to 24. In preferred embodiments, n is 1.
[0401] In preferred embodiments, the entire group -((R
1)
p-R
2)
n-(R
1)
p-R
3 has a molecular weight in a range of from 100 Da to 3000 Da. Preferably, the entire
group -((R
1)
p-R
2)
n-(R
1)
p-R
3 has a molecular weight in a range of from 100 Da to 2000 Da. More preferably, the
entire group -((R
1)
p-R
2)
n-(R
1)
p-R
3 has a molecular weight in a range of from 100 Da to 1500 Da, even more preferably
in a range of from 150 Da to 1500 Da. Even more preferably still, the entire group
-((R
1)
p-R
2)
n-(R
1)
p-R
3 has a molecular weight in a range of from 150 Da to 1000 Da, most preferably in a
range of from 200 Da to 1000 Da.
[0402] It is preferred that when n > 2, that R
2 is independently selected from the group consisting of C
1-C
6 alkylene groups, C
2-C
6 alkenylene groups, C
2-C
6 alkynylene groups, C
6-C
6 arylene, C
2-C
6 heteroarylene, C
3-C
6 cycloalkylene groups, and C
5-C
6 cycloalkenylene groups; and wherein preferably the alkylene groups, alkenylene groups,
alkynylene groups, cycloalkylene groups, cycloalkenylene groups, and cycloalkynylene
groups optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of O, S, NR
36, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0403] In preferred embodiments, the entire group -((R
1)
p-R
2)
n-(R
1)
p-R
3 satisfies molecules from Group R
M shown below.
RM:
[0404]

, wherein the wiggly line denotes a bond to a tetrazine group as disclosed herein
or to a group R
1 or R
2.
[0405] In preferred embodiments, the group -((R
1)
p-R
2)
n-(R
1)
p-R
3 satisfies molecules from Group R
M, wherein it is understood that when n is more than 1, -((R
1)
p-R
2)
n-(R
1)
p-R
3 may be preceded by a group -((R
1)
p-R
2)- so as to form a group -((R
1)
p-R
2)-((R
1)
p-R
2)
n-1-(R
1)
p-R
3. It is understood that this follows from the definition of how to write out the repeating
units, i.e. -((R
1)
p-R
2)
2- would first be written as -(R
1)
p-R
2-(R
1)
p-R
2- before R
1, p, and R
2 are independently selected.
R1, R2, and R3
[0406] R
1 is as defined for R
10. R
2 is as defined for R
11. R
3 is as defined for R
12.
R4
[0407] Preferably, each R
4 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C
1-C
24 alkyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
24 aryl, C
2-C
24 heteroaryl, C
3-C
24 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkenyl groups, and C
12-C
24 cycloalkynyl groups.
[0408] In a preferred embodiment, each R
4 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C
1-C
12 alkyl groups, C
2-C
12 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
12 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
12 aryl, C
2-C
12 heteroaryl, C
3-C
12 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkenyl groups, and C
12 cycloalkynyl groups.
[0409] In a preferred embodiment, each R
4 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C
1-C
4 alkyl groups, C
2-C
4 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
4 alkynyl groups, C
6 aryl, C
2-C
6 heteroaryl, C
3-C
8 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
8 cycloalkenyl groups, and C
8 cycloalkynyl groups.
[0410] Preferably, the R
4 groups not being hydrogen, optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from
the group consisting of O, S, NR
5, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0411] Preferably, the R
4 groups not being hydrogen, are optionally further substituted with one or more substituents
selected from the group consisting of - Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NR
5, -SR
5, C
1-C
24 alkyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
24 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
24 aryl groups, C
2-C
24 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
24 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkenyl groups, C
12-C
24 cycloalkynyl groups, C
3-C
24 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
24 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
24 (hetero)arylalkenyl groups, C
4-C
24 (hetero)arylalkynyl groups, C
4-C
24 alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
24 alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
24 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
6-C
24 alkylcycloalkenyl groups, C
13-C
24 alkylcycloalkynyl groups, C
4-C
24 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
6-C
24 cycloalkenylalkyl groups, C
13-C
24 cycloalkynylalkyl groups, C
5-C
24 alkenylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
24 alkenylcycloalkenyl groups, C
14-C
24 alkenylcycloalkynyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkylalkenyl groups, C
7-C
24 cycloalkenylalkenyl groups, C
14-C
24 cycloalkynylalkenyl groups, C
5-C
24 alkynylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
24 alkynylcycloalkenyl groups, C
14-C
24 alkynylcycloalkynyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkylalkynyl groups, C
7-C
24 cycloalkenylalkynyl groups, C
14-C
24 cycloalkynylalkynyl groups, C
5-C
24 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
7-C
24 cycloalkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
14-C
24 cycloalkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
5-C
24 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
24 (hetero)arylcycloalkenyl groups, and C
14-C
24 (hetero)arylcycloalkynyl groups; wherein the substituents optionally contain one
or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting of O, S, NR
5, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0412] Preferably, the R
4 groups not being hydrogen, are optionally further substituted with one or more substituents
selected from the group consisting of - Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NR
5, -SR
5, C
1-C
4 alkyl groups, C
2-C
4 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
4 alkynyl groups, C
6 aryl groups, C
2-C
4 heteroaryl groups, C
3-C
4 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
4 cycloalkenyl groups, C
12 cycloalkynyl groups, C
3-C
12 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
12 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 (hetero)arylalkenyl groups, C
4-C
12 (hetero)arylalkynyl groups, C
4-C
12 alkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
12 alkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
4-C
12 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
6-C
12 alkylcycloalkenyl groups, C
13-C
12 alkylcycloalkynyl groups, C
4-C
12 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
6-C
12 cycloalkenylalkyl groups, C
13 cycloalkynylalkyl groups, C
5-C
12 alkenylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
12 alkenylcycloalkenyl groups, C
14 alkenylcycloalkynyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkylalkenyl groups, C
7-C
12 cycloalkenylalkenyl groups, C
14 cycloalkynylalkenyl groups, C
5-C
12 alkynylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
12 alkynylcycloalkenyl groups, C
14-C
12 alkynylcycloalkynyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkylalkynyl groups, C
7-C
12 cycloalkenylalkynyl groups, C
14 cycloalkynylalkynyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
7-C
12 cycloalkenyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
14 cycloalkynyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
5-C
12 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, C
7-C
12 (hetero)arylcycloalkenyl groups, and C
14 (hetero)arylcycloalkynyl groups;
wherein the substituents optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from
the group consisting of O, S, NR
5, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0413] In a preferred embodiment, the R
4 substituents do not contain heteroatoms. In a preferred embodiment, the R
4 groups are not substituted.
[0414] In another preferred embodiment, the R
4 groups do not contain heteroatoms.
R5
[0415] Preferably, each R
5 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C
1-C
8 alkyl groups, C
2-C
8 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
8 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
12 aryl, C
2-C
12 heteroaryl, C
3-C
8 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
8 cycloalkenyl groups, C
3-C
12 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
12 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups and C
5-C
12 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, wherein the R
5 groups not being hydrogen are optionally substituted with a moiety selected from
the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NH, and -SH, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the
group consisting of O, S, NH, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally
oxidized, wherein the N atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0416] In a preferred embodiment, the R
5 groups are not substituted.
[0417] In another preferred embodiment, the R
5 groups do not contain heteroatoms.
Moieties Q, Q1, Q2, Q3, Q4
[0418] In preferred embodiments, g is an integer in a range of from 0 to 12, preferably
from 0 to 10, more preferably from 0 to 8, even more preferably from 1 to 6, most
preferably from 2 to 4. In other preferred embodiments g is 0. In case more than one
moiety selected from the group consisting of Q, Q
1, Q
2, Q
3, and Q
4 within one compound satisfies Formula (5), each g is independently selected.
[0419] In preferred embodiments, h is 0 or 1. In case more than one moiety selected from
the group consisting of Q, Q
1, Q
2, Q
3, and Q
4 within one compound satisfies Formula (5), each h is independently selected.
[0420] In preferred embodiments, each f belonging to a moiety Q, Q
1, Q
2, Q
3, or Q
4 is an integer independently selected from a range of from 0 to 24, preferably from
1 to 12, more preferably from 1 to 6, even more preferably from 1 to 3, most preferably
f is 0 or 1. In preferred embodiments f is preferably an integer from 12 to 24. In
other preferred embodiments, f is 1.
[0421] In preferred embodiments, the group -((R
10)
h-R
11)
n-(R
10)
h-R
12 satisfies molecules from Group R
M shown above.
[0422] In preferred embodiments, the group -((R
10)
h-R
11)
n-(R
10)
h-R
12 satisfies molecules from Group R
M, wherein it is understood that when n is more than 1, e.g. -((R
10)
h-R
11)
n-1-(R
10)
h-R
12 may be preceded by a group -(R
10)
h-R
11- so as to form a group -(R
10)
h-R
11-((R
10)
h-R
11)
n-1-(R
10)
h-R
12. It is understood that this follows from the definition of how to write out the repeating
units, i.e. -((R
10)
h-R
11)
2- would first be written as -(R
10)
h-R
11-(R
10)
h-R
11- before R
10, h, and R
11 are independently selected.
Formulae (14), (14a), (14b), (14c), (14d), (14e), and (14f)
[0423] In a preferred embodiment, the Cleaving Agent is a tetrazine satisfying Formula (14):

and preferably including pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, wherein, Y
a is selected from the group consisting of Y
1, Y
2, Y
3, Y
4, Y
5 and Y
6:

wherein, Y
b is selected from the group consisting of Y
1, Y
2, Y
3, Y
4, Y
5, Y
6, hydrogen, X
47, and -(S
P)
D-R
87; wherein SP is a spacer, preferably as defined herein, wherein D is 0 or 1, preferably
D is 0; wherein when Y
a is Y
6, then Y
b is hydrogen, wherein each Q
1 and Q
5, are individually selected from the group consisting of X
45, hydrogen, X
47 and -(S
P)
D-R
87; wherein each Q
2 and Q
4, are individually selected from the group consisting of X
46, hydrogen, X
47, and -(S
P)
D-R
87; wherein each Q
3 is individually selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, X
47, and -(S
P)
D-R
87; wherein preferably the compound of Formula (14) comprises at least one X
45 or X
46 group, wherein each X
45 individually is selected from the group consisting of N(X
50)
2, C(X
51)
2N(X
50)
2, NX
50C(O)X
51, NX
50C(S)X
51, OH, SH, C(O)OH, C(S)OH, C(O)SH, C(S)SH, NX
50C(O)OX
51, NX
50C(S)OX
51, NX
50C(O)SX
51, NX
50C(S)SX
51, NX
50C(O)N(X
51)
2, NX
50C(S)N(X
51)
2, NX
50SO
2X
51, NX
50SO
3X
51, NX
50OX
51, SO
3H, , SO
2N(X
51)
2, and PO
3H
2; wherein each X
46 individually is selected from the group consisting of N(X
50)
2, C(X
51)
2N(X
50)
2, NX
50C(O)X
51, NX
50C(S)X
51,, OH, SH, C(O)OH, C(S)OH, C(O)SH, C(S)SH, NX
50C(O)OX
51, NX
50C(S)OX
51, NX
50C(O)SX
51, NX
50C(S)SX
51, NX
50C(O)N(X
51)
2, NX
50C(S)N(X
51)
2, NX
50SO
2X
51, NX
50SO
3X
51, NX
50OX
51, SO
3H, and PO
3H
2; wherein each X
50 and X
51 individually is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, X
48, and -(S
P)
D-R
87; wherein each X
48 is preferably independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C
1-C
4 alkyl groups, C
2-C
4 alkenyl groups, and C
4-6 (hetero)aryl groups; wherein for X
48 the alkyl groups, alkenyl groups, and (hetero)aryl groups are optionally substituted
with a moiety selected from the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, =O, -SH, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2, and -NO
2; and optionally contain at most two heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of -O-, -S-, -NH-, -P-, and -Si-, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized,
wherein each X
47 is selected from the group consisting of -F,-Cl, -Br, -I, -OX
49, -N(X
49)
2, -SO
3, -PO
3-, -NO
2, -CF
3, -SX
49, S(=O)
2N(X
49)
2, OC(=O)X
49, SC(=O) X
49, OC(=S)X
49, SC(=S)X
49, NX
49C(=O)-X
49, NX
49C(=S)-X
49, NX
49C(=O)O-X
49, NX
49C(=S)O-X
49, NX
49C(=O)S-X
49, NX
49C(=S)S-X
49, OC(=O)N(X
49)
2, SC(=O)N(X
49)
2, OC(=S)N(X
49)
2, SC(=S)N(X
49)
2, NX
49C(=O)N(X
49)
2, NX
49C(=S)N(X
49)
2, C(=O)X
49, C(=S)X
49, C(=O)N(X
49)
2, C(=S)N(X
49)
2, C(=O)O-X
49, C(=O)S-X
49, C(=S)O-X
49, C(=S)S-X
49, -S(O)X
49, -S(O)
2X
49, NX
49S(O)
2X
49, -ON(X
49)
2,
-NX
49OX
49, C
1-C
8 alkyl groups, C
2-C
8 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
8 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
12 aryl, C
2-C
12 heteroaryl, C
3-C
8 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
8 cycloalkenyl groups, C
3-C
12 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
12 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups and C
5-C
12 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, wherein the alkyl groups, alkenyl groups, alkynyl
groups, aryl, heteroaryl, cycloalkyl groups, cycloalkenyl groups, alkyl(hetero)aryl
groups, (hetero)arylalkyl groups, alkylcycloalkyl groups, cycloalkylalkyl groups,
cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups and (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups are optionally substituted
with a moiety selected from the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OX
49, -N(X
49)
2, -SO
3X
49,-PO
3(X
49)
2, -PO
4(X
49)
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NX
49, and -SX
49, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of O, S, NX
49, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized, wherein the N
atoms are optionally quaternized; wherein X
49 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C
1-C
8 alkyl groups, C
2-C
8 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
8 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
12 aryl, C
2-C
12 heteroaryl, C
3-C
8 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
8 cycloalkenyl groups, C
3-C
12 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
12 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups and C
5-C
12 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, wherein the X
49 groups not being hydrogen are optionally substituted with a moiety selected from
the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NH, and -SH, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the
group consisting of O, S, NH, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally
oxidized, wherein the N atoms are optionally quaternized; wherein for each individual
Y
a and Y
b preferably at most two, more preferably at most one of Q
1, Q
2, Q
3, Q
4, and Q
5 are said R
87; wherein the compound according to Formula (14) preferably comprises at most four
R
87 moieties, more preferably at most two R
87 moieties, most preferably at most one R
87;wherein the compound according to Formula (14) preferably comprises at least one
R
87; wherein preferably for each individual Y
a and Y
b at most three, more preferably at most two of Q
1, Q
2, Q
3, Q
4, and Q
5 are not hydrogen; wherein preferably for each individual Y
a and Y
b at most two of Q
1, Q
2, Q
3, Q
4, and Q
5 are X
45 or X
46, wherein preferably for each individual Y
a and Y
b one of Q
1, Q
2, Q
4, and Q
5 is X
45 or X
46, wherein preferably both Y
a and Y
b comprise at least one X
45 or X
46, wherein preferably both Y
a and Y
b comprise one X
45 or X
46, wherein preferably both Y
a and Y
b comprise one X
45 or X
46, wherein preferably the X
45 comprised in Y
a is the same as the X
45 comprised in Y
b, and/or the X
46 comprised in Y
a is the same as the X
46 comprised in Y
b, wherein preferably Y
a and Y
b are both independently selected Y
1, or both independently selected Y
2, or both independently selected Y
3, or both independently selected Y
4, or both independently selected Y
5.
[0424] In a preferred embodiment, in Formula (14) or in any one of Formulae (14a)-(14f),
when Q
1 is a X
47 or -(S
P)
D-R
87, then for Q
1 the X
47 and the R
87 are not a group in accordance with the definition of X
45.
[0425] In a preferred embodiment, in Formula (14) or in any one of Formulae (14a)-(14f),
when Q
5 is a X
47 or -(S
P)
D-R
87, then for Q
5 the X
47 and the R
87 are not a group in accordance with the definition of X
45.
[0426] In a preferred embodiment, in Formula (14) or in any one of Formulae (14a)-(14f),
when Q
2 is a X
47 or -(S
P)
D-R
87, then for Q
2 the X
47 and the R
87 are not a group in accordance with the definition of X
46.
[0427] In a preferred embodiment, in Formula (14) or in any one of Formulae (14a)-(14f),
when Q
4 is a X
47 or -(S
P)
D-R
87, then for Q
4 the X
47 and the R
87 are not a group in accordance with the definition of X
46.
[0428] In preferred embodiments Y
a equals Y
b. In preferred embodiments Y
a is selected from Y
1, Y
2, Y
3, Y
4 or Y
5 and Y
b is hydrogen, X
47 or -(S
P)
D-R
87. In preferred embodiments Y
a is selected from Y
1, Y
2, Y
3, Y
4 or Y
5 and Y
b is hydrogen. In preferred embodiments the compound according to Formula (14) does
not comprise a R
87. In preferred embodiments, X
50 is hydrogen. In preferred embodiments when X
45 or X
46 is N(X
50)
2, then one X
50 is hydrogen and one X
50 is X
48 or -(S
P)
D-R
87. In preferred embodiments Formula (14) does not comprise X
46.
[0429] In preferred embodiments, the Cleaving Agent is a tetrazine satisfying any one of
Formulae (14a)-(14f):
wherein Q6 is as defined for Q1 in Formula (14), Q7 is as defined for Q2 in Formula (14), Q8 is as defined for Q3 in Formula (14), Q9 is as defined for Q4 in Formula (14), and Q10 is as defined for Q5 in Formula (14),
wherein preferably at most two, more preferably at most one of Q1, Q2, Q3, Q4, and Q5 are said -(SP)D-R87; wherein preferably at most two, more preferably at most one of Q6, Q7, Q8, Q9, and Q10 are said -(SP)D-R87; wherein preferably the compound according to any one of Formulae (14a) to (14f)
comprises at most four R87 moieties, more preferably at most two R87 moieties; wherein the compound according to Formulae (14a)-(14f) preferably comprises
at least one R87; wherein preferably at most six, more preferably at most four of Q1, Q2, Q3, Q4, Q5,Q6, Q7, Q8, Q9, Q10 are not hydrogen, wherein preferably the X45 or X46 groups are identical.
[0430] In a preferred embodiment, in Formulae (14b), (14b), and (14f) when Q
6 is a X
47 or -(S
P)
D-R
87, then for Q
6 the X
47 and the R
87 are not a group in accordance with the definition of X
45.
[0431] In a preferred embodiment, in Formulae (14c)-(14f) when Q
10 is a X
47 or-(S
P)
D-R
87, then for Q
10 the X
47 and the R
87 are not a group in accordance with the definition of X
45.
[0432] In a preferred embodiment, in Formulae (14a), (14c), and (14e) when Q
7 is a X
47 or -(S
P)
D-R
87, then for Q
7 the X
47 and the R
87 are not a group in accordance with the definition of X
46.
[0433] In a preferred embodiment, in Formulae (14a), (14b), (14e), and (14f) when Q
9 is a X
47 or -(S
P)
D-R
87, then for Q
9 the X
47 and the R
87 are not a group in accordance with the definition of X
46.
X45
[0434] In a preferred embodiment, each X
45 individually is selected from the group consisting of N(X
50)
2, NX
50C(O)X
51, NX
50C(S)X
51, OH, SH, NX
50C(O)OX
51, NX
50C(S)OX
51, NX
50C(O)SX
51, NX
50C(S)SX
51, NX
50C(O)N(X
51)
2, NX
50C(S)N(X
51)
2, NX
50SO
2X
51, NX
50SO
3X
51, NX
50OX
51, and SO
2N(X
51)
2.
[0435] In a preferred embodiment, each X
45 individually is selected from the group consisting of N(X
50)
2, NX
50C(O)X
51, NX
50C(S)X
51, OH and SH.
[0436] In a preferred embodiment, each X
45 individually is selected from the group consisting of NX
50C(O)OX
51, NX
50C(S)OX
51, NX
50C(O)SX
51, NX
50C(S)SX
51, NX
50C(O)N(X
51)
2, NX
50C(S)N(X
51)
2, NX
50SO
2X
51, NX
50SO
3X
51, NX
50OX
51,
[0437] In a preferred embodiment, X
45 is selected from the group consisting of NHX
50, C(X
51)
2NH
2, CHX
51NH
2, CH
2N(X
50)
2, CH
2NHX
50, NHC(O)X
51, NHC(S)X
51, OH, and SH. In a preferred embodiment, X
45 is NHX
50. In a preferred embodiment, X
45 is C(X
51)
2NH
2. In a preferred embodiment, X
45 is CHX
51NH
2. In a preferred embodiment, X
45 is CH
2N(X
50)
2. In a preferred embodiment, X
45 is CH
2NHX
50.
[0438] In a preferred embodiment, X
45 is NH
2. In a preferred embodiment, X
45 is CH
2NH
2. In a preferred embodiment, X
45 is NHC(O)X
51. In a preferred embodiment, X
45 is NHC(S)X
51. In a preferred embodiment, X
45 is OH.
[0439] In a preferred embodiment, X
45 is SH. In a preferred embodiment, X
45 is SO
2NH
2.
X46
[0440] In a preferred embodiment, X
46 is individually selected from the group consisting of N(X
50)
2, NX
50C(O)X
51, NX
50C(O)OX
51, andNX
50C(O)N(X
51)
2,. In a preferred embodiment, X
46 is selected from the group consisting of N(X
50)
2, and NX
50C(O)X
51,. In a preferred embodiment, X
46 is selected from the group consisting of NHX
50 and NHC(O)X
51. In a preferred embodiment, X
46 is NHX
50. In a preferred embodiment, X
46 is NH
2. In a preferred embodiment, X
46 is NHC(O)X
51.
X47
[0441] In a preferred embodiment, each X
47 is individually selected from the group consisting of F, -OH, -NH
2, -SO
3-, -NO
2, -CF
3, -SH, C
1-C
6 alkyl groups, C
6 aryl groups, C
4-C
5 heteroaryl groups, C
5-C
8 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
5-C
8 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
8 alkylcycloalkyl groups, and C
4-C
8 cycloalkylalkyl groups. In a more preferred embodiment, each X
47 is individually selected from the group consisting of F, -SO
3; -NO
2, -CF
3, C
1-C
6 alkyl groups, C
6 aryl groups, C
4-C
5 heteroaryl groups, C
5-C
8 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
5-C
8 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
8 alkylcycloalkyl groups, and C
4-C
8 cycloalkylalkyl groups.
[0442] In a preferred embodiment, the X
47 substituents do not contain heteroatoms.
[0443] In a preferred embodiment, the X
47 groups are not substituted.
[0444] In another preferred embodiment, the X
47 groups do not contain heteroatoms.
X48
[0445] In a preferred embodiment, each X
48 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C
1-C
4 alkyl groups, C
2-C
4 alkenyl groups, and C
4-6 (hetero)aryl groups. For X
48 the alkyl groups, alkenyl groups, and (hetero)aryl groups are optionally substituted
with a moiety selected from the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, =O, -SH, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2 and -NO
2; and optionally contain at most two heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of -O-, -S-, -NH-, -P-, and -Si-, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized.
In a preferred embodiment, X
48 is C
1-C
4 alkyl.
[0446] In a preferred embodiment, the X
48 substituents do not contain heteroatoms.
[0447] In a preferred embodiment, the X
48 groups are not substituted.
[0448] In another preferred embodiment, the X
48 groups do not contain heteroatoms.
X49
[0449] In preferred embodiments, X
49 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C
1-C
8 alkyl groups, C
2-C
8 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
8 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
12 aryl, C
2-C
12 heteroaryl, C
3-C
8 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
8 cycloalkenyl groups, C
3-C
12 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
12 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
4-C
12 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
5-C
12 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups and C
5-C
12 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, wherein the X
49 groups not being hydrogen are optionally substituted with a moiety selected from
the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NH, and -SH, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the
group consisting of O, S, NH, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally
oxidized, wherein the N atoms are optionally quaternized.
[0450] In preferred embodiments, X
49 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C
1-C
4 alkyl groups, C
2-C
4 alkenyl groups, C
2-C
4 alkynyl groups, C
6-C
8 aryl, C
2-C
8 heteroaryl, C
3-C
6 cycloalkyl groups, C
5-C
6 cycloalkenyl groups, C
3-C
10 alkyl(hetero)aryl groups, C
3-C
10 (hetero)arylalkyl groups, C
4-C
8 alkylcycloalkyl groups, C
4-C
8 cycloalkylalkyl groups, C
5-C
10 cycloalkyl(hetero)aryl groups and C
5-C
10 (hetero)arylcycloalkyl groups, wherein the X
49 groups not being hydrogen are optionally substituted with a moiety selected from
the group consisting of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2, -NO
2, -CF
3, =O, =NH, and -SH, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the
group consisting of O, S, NH, P, and Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally
oxidized, wherein the N atoms are optionally quaternized. In a preferred embodiment,
the X
49 substituents do not contain heteroatoms. In a preferred embodiment, the X
49 groups are not substituted. In another preferred embodiment, the X
49 groups do not contain heteroatoms.
X50
[0451] In a preferred embodiment, each X
50 is individually selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, X
48, and -(S
P)
D-R
87. In a preferred embodiment, X
50 is X
48. In a preferred embodiment, X
50 is -(S
P)
D-R
87. In a preferred embodiment, X
50 is H.
X51
[0452] In a preferred embodiment, each X
51 is individually selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, X
48, and -(S
P)
D-R
87. In a preferred embodiment, X
51 is X
48. In a preferred embodiment, X
51 is -(S
P)
D-R
87. In a preferred embodiment, X
51 is H.
Q1
[0453] In a preferred embodiment, in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) Q
1 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, X
47, and -(S
P)
D-R
87. In a preferred embodiment, Q
1 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is hydrogen. In a preferred embodiment, Q
1 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is X
47. In a preferred embodiment, Q
1 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is a R
87, and preferably Q
2, Q
3, Q
4, Q
5, Q
6, Q
7, Q
8, Q
9, and Q
10 are X
45, X
46, or hydrogen.
Q2
[0454] In a preferred embodiment, Q
2 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen
X
47, and -(S
P)
D-R
87. In a preferred embodiment, Q
2 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is hydrogen. In a preferred embodiment, Q
2 is in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) X
47. In a preferred embodiment, Q
2 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is -(S
P)
D-R
87, and preferably Q
1, Q
3, Q
4, Q
5, Q
6, Q
7, Q
8, Q
9, and Q
10 are X
45, X
46, or hydrogen.
Q3
[0455] In a preferred embodiment, Q
3 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen
X
47, and -(S
P)
D-R
87. In a preferred embodiment, Q
3 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is hydrogen. In a preferred embodiment, Q
3 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is X
47. In a preferred embodiment, Q
3 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is -(S
P)
D-R
87, and preferably Q
1, Q
2, Q
4, Q
5, Q
6, Q
7, Q
8, Q
9, and Q
10 are X
45, X
46, or hydrogen.
Q4
[0456] In a preferred embodiment, Q
4 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen
X
47, and -(S
P)
D-R
87. In a preferred embodiment, Q
4 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is hydrogen. In a preferred embodiment, Q
4 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is X
47. In a preferred embodiment, Q
4 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is -(S
P)
D-R
87, and preferably Q
1, Q
2, Q
3, Q
5, Q
6, Q
7, Q
8, Q
9 and Q
10 are X
45, X
46, or hydrogen.
Q5
[0457] In a preferred embodiment, Q
5 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen
X
47, and -(S
P)
D-R
87. In a preferred embodiment, Q
5 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is hydrogen. In a preferred embodiment, Q
5 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is X
47. In a preferred embodiment, Q
5 is -(S
P)
D-R
87, and preferably Q
1, Q
2, Q
3, Q
4, Q
6, Q
7, Q
8, Q
9 and Q
10 are X
45, X
46, or hydrogen.
Q6
[0458] In a preferred embodiment, Q
6 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen
X
47, and -(S
P)
D-R
87. In a preferred embodiment, Q
6 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is hydrogen. In a preferred embodiment, Q
6 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is X
47. In a preferred embodiment, Q
6 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is -(S
P)
D-R
87, and preferably Q
1, Q
2, Q
3, Q
4, Q
5, Q
7, Q
8, Q
9 and Q
10 are X
45, X
46, or hydrogen.
Q7
[0459] In a preferred embodiment, Q
7 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen
X
47, and -(S
P)
D-R
87. In a preferred embodiment, Q
7 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is hydrogen. In a preferred embodiment, Q
7 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is X
47. In a preferred embodiment, Q
7 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is -(S
P)
D-R
87, and preferably Q
1, Q
2, Q
3, Q
4, Q
5, Q
6, Q
8, Q
9 and Q
10 are X
45, X
46, or hydrogen.
Q8
[0460] In a preferred embodiment, Q
8 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen
X
47, and -(S
P)
D-R
87. In a preferred embodiment, Q
8 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is hydrogen. In a preferred embodiment, Q
8 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is X
47. In a preferred embodiment, Q
8 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is -(S
P)
D-R
87, and preferably Q
1, Q
2, Q
3, Q
4, Q
5, Q
6, Q
7, Q
9 and Q
10 are X
45, X
46, or hydrogen.
Q9
[0461] In a preferred embodiment, Q
9 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen
X
47, and -(S
P)
D-R
87. In a preferred embodiment, Q
9 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is hydrogen. In a preferred embodiment, Q
9 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is X
47. In a preferred embodiment, Q
9 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is -(S
P)
D-R
87, and preferably Q
1, Q
2, Q
3, Q
4, Q
5, Q
6, Q
7, Q
8 and Q
10 are X
45, X
46, or hydrogen.
Q10
[0462] In a preferred embodiment, Q
10 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen
X
47, and -(S
P)
D-R
87. In a preferred embodiment, Q
10 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is hydrogen. In a preferred embodiment, Q
10 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is X
47. In a preferred embodiment, Q
10 in any one of Formulae (14)-(14f) is -(S
P)
D-R
87, and preferably Q
1, Q
2, Q
3, Q
4, Q
5, Q
6, Q
7, Q
8 and Q
9 are X
45, X
46, or hydrogen.
Formula (14a)
[0463] In a preferred embodiment, the compound according to the invention is a compound
according to Formula (14a), wherein preferably, each individual X
45 and Q
2-Q
4, Q
7-Q
9 are as described herein.
[0464] In a preferred embodiment, the compound according to the invention is a compound
according to Formula (14a), wherein both X
45 are the same and are selected from the group consisting of NH
2, NHC(O)X
51, NX
50C(O)OX
51, NX
50C(O)N(X
51)
2, NX
50C(S)N(X
51)
2, OH, and SH; and Q
2-Q
4, Q
7-Q
9 are hydrogen.
[0465] In a preferred embodiment, the compound according to the invention is a compound
according to Formula (14a), wherein both X
45 are the same and are selected from the group consisting of NH
2, NHC(O)X
51, and OH; and Q
2-Q
4, Q
7-Q
9 are hydrogen.
Formula (14b)
[0466] In a preferred embodiment, the compound according to the invention is a compound
according to Formula (14b), wherein preferably, each individual X
46 and Q
1, Q
3-Q
4, Q
6, Q
8-Q
9 are as described herein.
[0467] In a preferred embodiment, the compound according to the invention is a compound
according to Formula (14b), wherein both X
46 are the same and are NH
2 or NHC(O)X
51, and Q
1, Q
3-Q
4, Q
6, Q
8-Q
9 are hydrogen.
Formula (14c)
[0468] In a preferred embodiment, the compound according to the invention is a compound
according to Formula (14c), wherein preferably, each individual X
45 and Q
2-Q
3, Q
5, Q
7,Q
8, Q
10 are as described herein.
[0469] In a preferred embodiment, the compound according to the invention is a compound
according to Formula (14c), wherein both X
45 are the same and are selected from the group consisting of NH
2, NHC(O)X
51, NX
50C(O)OX
51, NX
50C(O)N(X
51)
2, NX
50C(S)N(X
51)
2, OH, and SH; and Q
2-Q
3, Q
5, Q
7,Q
8, Q
10 are hydrogen.
[0470] In a preferred embodiment, the compound according to the invention is a compound
according to Formula (14c), wherein both X
45 are the same and are NH
2, NHC(O)X
51, and OH, and Q
2-Q
3, Q
5, Q
7,Q
8, Q
10 are hydrogen.
Formula (14d)
[0471] In a preferred embodiment, the compound according to the invention is a compound
according to Formula (14d), wherein preferably each individual X
46 and Q
1, Q
3, Q
5, Q
6, Q
8, Q
10 are as described herein.
[0472] In a preferred embodiment, the compound according to the invention is a compound
according to Formula (14d), wherein both X
46 are the same and are NH
2 or NHC(O)X
51, and Q
1, Q
3, Q
5, Q
6, Q
8, Q
10 are hydrogen.
Formula (14e)
[0473] In a preferred embodiment, the compound according to the invention is a compound
according to Formula (14e), wherein preferably each individual X
45 and Q
2, Q
4, Q
5, Q
7, Q
9, Q
10 are as described herein.
[0474] In a preferred embodiment, the compound according to the invention is a compound
according to Formula (14e), wherein both X
45 are the same and are selected from the group consisting of NH
2, NHC(O)X
51, NX
50C(O)OX
51, NX
50C(O)N(X
51)
2, NX
50C(S)N(X
51)
2, OH, and SH; and Q
2, Q
4, Q
5, Q
7, Q
9, Q
10 are hydrogen.
[0475] In a preferred embodiment, the compound according to the invention is a compound
according to Formula (14e), wherein both X
45 are the same and are NH
2, NHC(O)X
51, and OH, and Q
2, Q
4, Q
5, Q
7, Q
9, Q
10 are hydrogen.
Formula (14f)
[0476] In a preferred embodiment, the compound according to the invention is a compound
according to Formula (14f), wherein preferably each individual X
46 and Q
1, Q
4, Q
5, Q
6, Q
9, Q
10 are as described herein.
[0477] In a preferred embodiment, the compound according to the invention is a compound
according to Formula (14f), wherein both X
46 are the same and are NH
2 or NHC(O)X
51, and Q
1, Q
4, Q
5, Q
6, Q
9, Q
10 are hydrogen.
[0478] In a preferred embodiment, the Cleaving Agent is according to Formula (14) and comprises
at least one, preferably two, X
45 groups.
[0479] In a preferred embodiment, the Cleaving Agent is according to Formula (14a), (14c),
or (14e).
R87
[0480] Preferably, a R
87 in relation to the invention is a moiety that modulates the pharmacokinetics of a
compound. Thus, in a preferred embodiment R
87 is a pharmacokinetics-modulating moiety (P
K moiety). The functions of the R
87 include, but are not limited to, one or more of delaying clearance of said compound,
affecting the volume of distribution of said compound (e.g. reducing or increasing
the volume of distribution), affecting the biodistribution of said compound, achieving
spatial control over its reaction with the Trigger, affecting (more particularly avoiding)
the metabolism of said compound, and/or affecting (more particularly avoiding) the
(undesired) sticking or (undesired) uptake of said compound to tissues. The skilled
person is well aware of such groups, and how to synthesize these.
[0481] In preferred embodiments, each R
87 is independently selected from the group consisting of organic molecules, inorganic
molecules, organometallic molecules, resins, beads, glass, microparticles, nanoparticles,
gels, surfaces, and cells. Preferably, R
87 is independently selected from the group consisting of organic molecules, and inorganic
molecules.
[0482] In a preferred embodiment the R
87 serves to increase the blood circulation time, increasing reaction time with the
Trigger.
[0483] In a preferred embodiment the R
87 serves modulate the pharmacokinetics of a reaction product between a dienophile of
this invention and a diene as defined herein.
[0484] Without wishing to be bound by theory, it is believed that the function and performance
of the tetrazine as defined herein in a bioorthogonal reaction is not significantly
affected by the nature of the R
87.
[0485] In a preferred embodiment, each R
87 is individually selected from the group consisting of biomolecule, polymer, peptide,
peptoid, dendrimer, protein, carbohydrate, oligonucleotide, oligosaccharide, aptamer,
steroid, lipid, albumin, albumin-binding moiety, dye moiety, fluorescent moiety, imaging
probe, and a Targeting Agent (T
T); and wherein the R
87 is optionally bound to the tetrazine via a Spacer (S
P). Typically, a suitable polymer as a R
87 is polyethyleneglycol (PEG). Such suitable PEG includes PEG with a number of repeating
units in a range of from 2 to 4000, and PEG with a molecular weight in a range of
from 200 Da to 100,000 Da.
[0486] In a preferred embodiment, the R
87 is a moiety according to Formula (5).
[0487] In a preferred embodiment, the R
87 is a moiety according to Formula (5), and is directly linked to the remainder of
a compound according to any one of Formulae (14)-(14f), for example without a spacer
S
P between the R
87 and the remainder of the moiety Y
a or Y
b of Formula (14) or the pyridyl moiety of the compound according to any one of Formulae
(14a)-(14f).
[0488] In a preferred embodiment, the R
87 is a moiety according to Formula (5), and is directly linked to the remainder of
a, for example without a spacer S
P between the R
87 and the remainder of the moiety Y
a or Y
b of any one of Formulae (4), (11), and (14); or the pyridyl moiety of the compound
according to any one of Formulae (14a)-(14f), and if attached to an amine functionality
of X
45 or X
46, z in Formula (5) is not 0.
[0489] In a preferred embodiment, the R
87 is linked to the remainder of a compound via a spacer S
P as defined herein.
[0490] In a preferred embodiment, the R
87 is linked to the remainder of a compound optionally via a spacer S
P as defined herein and each R
87 is individually selected from the group consisting of biomolecule, polymer, peptide,
peptoid, dendrimer, protein, carbohydrate, oligonucleotide, oligosaccharide, lipid,
micelle, liposomes, polymersome, particle, nanoparticle, microparticle, bead, gel,
metal complex, organometallic moiety, albumin, albumin-binding moiety, dye moiety,
fluorescent moiety, imaging probe, and a Targeting Agent (T
T).
[0491] In a preferred embodiment, one or multiple copies of the compound of the invention
may be conjugated to a R
87 that is a membrane translocation moiety (e.g. adamantine, poly-lysine/arginine, TAT,
human lactoferrin) to reach an intracellular Prodrug. Exemplary references regarding
such moieties include:
Trends in Biochemical Sciences, 2015,. 40, 12, 749;
J. Am. Chem. Soc. 2015, 137, 12153-12160;
Pharmaceutical Research, 2007, 24, 11, 1977.
[0492] With respect to application in a cellular environment, such as in vivo, depending
on the position of the Trigger-Construct (e.g. inside the cell or outside the cell)
the Cleaving Agent is designed to be able to effectively reach this Trigger-Construct.
Therefore, the Cleaving Agent can for example be tailored by varying its log P value,
its reactivity or its charge, and this can optionally be achieved by the R
87.
[0493] In a preferred embodiment, the tetrazine compounds of the invention comprise an imaging
moiety instead of a R
87. In other embodiments, the R
87 is or comprises an imaging moiety. In this preferred embodiment the imaging moiety
is bound to the remainder of the compounds of the invention in the same way as the
R
87. In this embodiment the R
87 equals an imaging moiety. In a preferred embodiment, the compounds of the invention
can comprise one or more imaging moieties and one or more R
87 moieties.
[0494] In a preferred embodiment, the R
87 is or comprises an imaging moiety.
[0495] Preferred imaging moieties are radionuclide-chelates complexes, radiolabeled molecules
(e.g. with
18F,
124I), and fluorescent dyes.
[0496] In a preferred embodiment, the R
87 is an imaging moiety that comprises at least one
18F isotope.
[0497] In a preferred embodiment, the R
87 comprises a chelating moiety, preferably a chelating moiety as described herein.
[0498] In a preferred embodiment, the R
87 includes but is not limited to amino acids, nucleosides, nucleotides, carbohydrates,
and biopolymer fragments, such as oligo- or polypeptides, oligo- or polypeptoids,
or oligo- or polylactides, or oligo- or poly-carbohydrates, oligonucleotides, varying
from 2 to 200, particularly 2 to 113, preferably 2 to 50, more preferably 2 to 24
and more preferably 2 to 12 repeating units.
[0499] According to one embodiment, the Cleaving Agent can be a multimeric compound, comprising
a plurality of tetrazines. According to one preferred embodiment, the Cleaving Agent
can be a multimeric compound, comprising a plurality of tetrazines bound to one R
87. These multimeric compounds can be but are not limited to biomolecules, peptide,
peptoid, protein, oligonucleotide, oligosaccharide, polymersome, bead, gel, polymers,
dendrimers, liposomes, micelles, particles, polymer particles, or other polymeric
constructs.
[0500] In a preferred embodiment, the R
87 is a polymer. This includes linear or branched polyalkylene glycols such as polyethylene
glycol (PEG) or polypropylene glycol (PPG) chains varying from 2 to 200, particularly
2 to 113, preferably 2 to 50, more preferably 2 to 24 and more preferably 2 to 12
repeating units. It is preferred that when polyalkylene glycols such as PEG and PPG
polymers are only bound via one end of the polymer chain, that the other end is terminated
with -OCH
3, -OCH
2CH
3, OCH
2CH
2CO
2H.
[0501] Other polymeric R
87 moieties are polymers and copolymers such as poly-(2-oxazoline, poly(N-(2-hydroxypropyl)methacrylamide)
(HPMA), polylactic acid (PLA), polylactic-glycolic acid (PLGA), polyglutamic acid
(PG), dextran, polyvinylpyrrolidone (PVP), poly(1-hydroxymethylethylene hydroxymethyl-formal
(PHF). Other exemplary polymers are polysaccharides, glycopolysaccharides, glycolipids,
polyglycoside, polyacetals, polyketals, polyamides, polyethers, polyesters. Examples
of naturally occurring polysaccharides that can be used are cellulose, amylose, dextran,
dextrin, levan, fucoidan, carraginan, inulin, pectin, amylopectin, glycogen, lixenan,
agarose, hyaluronan, chondroitinsulfate, dermatansulfate, keratansulfate, alginic
acid and heparin. In yet other exemplary embodiments, the polymer is a copolymer of
a polyacetal/polyketal and a hydrophilic polymer selected from the group consisting
of polyacrylates, polyvinyl polymers, polyesters, polyorthoesters, polyamides, oligopeptides,
polypeptides and derivatives thereof. Exemplary preferred polymeric R
87 moieties are PEG, HPMA, PLA, PLGA, PVP, PHF, dextran, oligopeptides, and polypeptides.
[0502] In some aspects of the invention polymeric R
87 moieties have a molecular weight ranging from 2 to 200 kDa, from 2 to 100 kDa, from
2 to 80 kDa, from 2 to 60 kDa, from 2 to 40 kDa, from 2 to 20 kDa, from 3 to 15 kDa,
from 5 to 10 kDa, from 500 dalton to 5 kDa.
[0503] Other exemplary R
87 moieties are dendrimers, such as polypropylene imine) (PPI) dendrimers, PAMAM dendrimers,
and glycol based dendrimers.
[0504] In a preferred embodiment the R
87 equals Group R
M.
[0505] In a preferred embodiment the R
87 serves to increase the blood circulation time, increasing reaction time with the
Trigger.
[0506] In a preferred embodiment the R
87 serves to modulate the pharmacokinetics of a reaction product between a dienophile
and diene of this invention.
[0507] In a preferred embodiment, the Cleaving Agent is designed to be cell impermeable
as a result of its log P value or its charge, and this can optionally be achieved
by the R
87.
[0508] In embodiments where it is required that the Cleaving Agent has an extracellular
volume of distribution it is preferred that the Log P of the Cleaving Agent is at
most 2, preferably at most 1, more preferably at most 0, even more preferably at most
-1.
[0509] In embodiments where it is required that the Cleaving Agent has an intracellular
volume of distribution it is preferred that the Log P of the Cleaving Agent is at
least -1, preferably at least 0, more preferably at least 1, even more preferably
at least 2.
[0510] In embodiments where it is required that the Cleaving Agent has an extracellular
volume of distribution it is preferred that the Agent has a negative net charge at
pH 7.
[0511] In embodiments where it is required that the Cleaving Agent has an intracellular
volume of distribution it is preferred that the Agent has a molecular weight of less
than 1000 Da, preferably less than 500 Da.
[0512] In embodiments where it is required that the Cleaving Agent has an extracellular
volume of distribution it is preferred that the Agent has a molecular weight of more
than 500 Da, preferably more than 1 kDa, more preferably more than 2 kDa.
[0513] In embodiments where it is required that the Cleaving Agent has slow or inefficient
extravasation from circulation into tissues it is preferred that the Agent has a molecular
weight of more than 5 kDa, preferably more than 60 Da, more preferably more than 150
Da, even more preferably more than 500 kDa,
[0514] In preferred embodiments wherein the Cleaving Agent is not cell permeable, R
87 can be a protein or polymer,
[0515] In preferred embodiments the R
87 reduces the extravasation of the Cleaving Agent from blood into target tissue, by
virtue of its large size and/or by the presence of a clearance-directing group (i.e.
as R
98). For example, R
87 being a PLGA microparticle will allow efficient IEDDA reaction with Administration
Agent in circulation but will hamper efficient extravasation of the Cleaving Agent
into tumor tissue, and will result in rapid clearance by the liver. Likewise, R
87 being an albumin protein modified with ca. 10 galactose moieties (i.e. clearance-directing
groups, as R
98) to ensure rapid uptake by the liver, affords efficient IEDDA reaction in blood with
no or minimal in mimizing extravasation into tumor tissue. Reference is made to [
Rossin et al J. Nucl. Med. 2013, 4, 11, 1989-1995]. Likewise R
87 can be a small moiety comprising a Clearance-directing group to favor IEDDA reaction
in blood vs. in tumor tissue.
[0516] Conversely, if whole body extracellular Label cleavage is desired the R
87 can be a 20 or 40 kDa PEG or albumin or an albumin-binding moiety ensuring prolonged
retention in circulation, optionally combined with EPR based targeting of tumor tissue.
[0517] In one embodiment the Administration Agent specifically binds or complexes with a
cell surface molecule, such as a cell surface receptor or antigen, for a given cell
population. Following specific binding or complexing with the receptor, the cell is
permissive for uptake of the Administration Agent, which then internalizes into the
cell. The subsequently administered Cleaving Agent will then enter the cell and cleave
the Administration Agent, releasing the Effector Moiety inside the cell. In another
embodiment the Administration Agent specifically binds or complexes with a cell surface
molecule, such as a cell surface receptor or antigen, for a given cell population.
Following specific binding or complexing the receptor, the cell is not permissive
for uptake of the Administration Agent. The subsequently administered Cleaving Agent
will then cleave the Administration Agent on the outside of the cell.
[0518] In an image cycling embodiment, centered on sequential imaging procedures of the
same or different Primary Targets, it is preferred that the Cleaving Agent acts systemically
(i.e. in the whole body). In other image cycling embodiments it is preferred that
the Cleaving Agent comprises a R
87 that is a T
T and selectively cleaves the Label at the Primary Target being imaged.
Targeting Agent TT
[0519] In preferred embodiments, a Targeting Agent T
T is used to bind a Primary Target.
[0520] In preferred embodiments, the dienes of this invention are bound to a Targeting Agent
T
T. A T
T bound to a diene can be advantageously used in relation to the invention, as a T
T may direct the diene to, or retain the diene at a location where the Label needs
to be released from the compound of Formula (1). For example, to increase the target/non-target
ratio of the Label, it may be preferred to direct the diene to, or retain the diene
in the blood if that is not the target. Then, the Cleaving Agent will mainly release
the Label in the blood, after which the Label is rapidly cleared. The Label at the
target (e.g. a tumor) is not released, thus increasing the target/non-target ratio
of the Label.
[0521] In preferred embodiments the T
T is used in affecting (more particularly avoiding) the metabolism of the diene, and/or
affecting (more particularly avoiding) the (undesired) sticking or (undesired) uptake
of the diene to tissues. In preferred embodiments, the T
T is an Administration Agent.
[0522] The skilled person is well aware of such groups, and how to synthesize these.
[0523] In a preferred embodiment, the T
T is selected from the group consisting of polymer, polymer particle, peptide, peptoid,
dendrimer, protein, carbohydrate, oligonucleotide, oligosaccharide, lipid, liposome,
albumin, albumin-binding moiety. Typically, a suitable polymer is polyethyleneglycol
(PEG). Such suitable PEG includes PEG with a number of repeating units in a range
of from 2 to 4000, and PEG with a molecular weight in a range of from 200 Da to 100,000
Da.
[0524] In a preferred embodiment, the T
T bound to the diene includes but is not limited to amino acids, nucleosides, nucleotides,
carbohydrates, and biopolymer fragments, such as oligo- or polypeptides, oligo- or
polypeptoids, or oligo- or polylactides, or oligo- or poly-carbohydrates, oligonucleotides,
varying from 2 to 200, particularly 2 to 113, preferably 2 to 50, more preferably
2 to 24 and more preferably 2 to 12 repeating units.
[0525] In a preferred embodiment, the T
T bound to the diene is a polymer. This includes linear or branched polyalkylene glycols
such as polyethylene glycol (PEG) or polypropylene glycol (PPG) chains varying from
2 to 200, particularly 2 to 113, preferably 2 to 50, more preferably 2 to 24 and more
preferably 2 to 12 repeating units. It is preferred that when polyalkylene glycols
such as PEG and PPG polymers are only bound via one end of the polymer chain, that
the other end is terminated with -OCH
3, -OCH
2CH
3, OCH
2CH
2CO
2H.
[0526] Other suitable polymeric T
T Moieties include polymers and copolymers such as poly-(2-oxazoline), poly(N-(2-hydroxypropyl)methacrylamide)
(HPMA), polylactic acid (PLA), polylactic-glycolic acid (PLGA), polyglutamic acid
(PG), dextran, polyvinylpyrrolidone (PVP), poly(1-hydroxymethylethylene hydroxymethyl-formal
(PHF). Other exemplary polymers are polysaccharides, glycopolysaccharides, glycolipids,
polyglycoside, polyacetals, polyketals, polyamides, polyethers, polyesters. Examples
of naturally occurring polysaccharides that can be used are cellulose, amylose, dextran,
dextrin, levan, fucoidan, carraginan, inulin, pectin, amylopectin, glycogen, lixenan,
agarose, hyaluronan, chondroitinsulfate, dermatansulfate, keratansulfate, alginic
acid and heparin. In yet other exemplary embodiments, the polymer is a copolymer of
a polyacetal/polyketal and a hydrophilic polymer selected from the group consisting
of polyacrylates, polyvinyl polymers, polyesters, polyorthoesters, polyamides, oligopeptides,
polypeptides and derivatives thereof. Exemplary preferred polymeric T
T moieties are PEG, HPMA, PLA, PLGA, PVP, PHF, dextran, oligopeptides, and polypeptides.
[0527] In some aspects of the invention polymeric T
T moieties have a molecular weight ranging from 2 to 200 kDa, from 2 to 100 kDa, from
2 to 80 kDa, from 2 to 60 kDa, from 2 to 40 kDa, from 2 to 20 kDa, from 3 to 15 kDa,
from 5 to 10 kDa, from 500 dalton to 5 kDa.
[0528] Other exemplary T
T Moieties are dendrimers, such as polypropylene imine) (PPI) dendrimers, PAMAM dendrimers,
and glycol based dendrimers.
[0529] In a preferred embodiment, the diene comprises an imaging moiety, for example a optical
or fluorescent dye, or a radioactive isotope such as
18F. Preferably, the diene does not comprise a radionuclide.
[0530] It will be understood that chemical modifications may also be made to the tetrazine
and the Targeting Agent, in order to make reactions of that compound more convenient
for purposes of preparing conjugates of the invention.
[0531] In preferred embodiments, a Targeting Agent, T
T, binds to a Primary Target. In order to allow specific targeting of the above-listed
Primary Targets, the Targeting Agent T
T can comprise compounds including but not limited to antibodies, antibody derivatives,
antibody fragments, antibody (fragment) fusions (e.g. bi-specific and tri-specific
mAb fragments or derivatives), proteins, peptides, e.g. octreotide and derivatives,
VIP, MSH, LHRH, chemotactic peptides, cell penetrating peptide, membrane translocation
moiety, bombesin, elastin, peptide mimetics, organic compounds, inorganic compounds,
carbohydrates, monosaccharides, oligosacharides, polysaccharides, oligonucleotides,
aptamers, viruses, whole cells, phage, drugs, polymers, liposomes, chemotherapeutic
agents, receptor agonists and antagonists, cytokines, hormones, steroids, toxins.
Examples of organic compounds envisaged within the context of the present invention
are, or are derived from, dyes, compounds targeting CAIX and PSMA, estrogens, e.g.
estradiol, androgens, progestins, corticosteroids, methotrexate, folic acid, and cholesterol.
[0532] According to a particular embodiment of the present invention, the Primary Target
is a receptor and a Targeting Agent is employed, which is capable of specific binding
to the Primary Target. Suitable Targeting Agents include but are not limited to, the
ligand of such a receptor or a part thereof which still binds to the receptor, e.g.
a receptor binding peptide in the case of receptor binding protein ligands. Other
examples of Targeting Agents of protein nature include insulin, transferrin, fibrinogen-gamma
fragment, thrombospondin, claudin, apolipoprotein E, Affibody molecules such as for
example ABY-025, Ankyrin repeat proteins, ankyrin-like repeat proteins, interferons,
e.g. alpha, beta, and gamma interferon, interleukins, lymphokines, colony stimulating
factors and protein growth factor, such as tumor growth factor, e.g. alpha, beta tumor
growth factor, platelet-derived growth factor (PDGF), uPAR targeting protein, apolipoprotein,
LDL, annexin V, endostatin, and angiostatin. Alternative examples of targeting agents
include DNA, RNA, PNA and LNA which are e.g. complementary to the Primary Target.
[0533] Examples of peptides as targeting agents include LHRH receptor targeting peptides,
EC-1 peptide, RGD peptides, HER2-targeting peptides, PSMA targeting peptides, somatostatin-targeting
peptides, bombesin. Other examples of targeting agents include lipocalins, such as
anticalins. One particular embodiment uses Affibodies
™ and multimers and derivatives.
[0534] In a preferred embodiment the T
T is selected from antibodies and antibody derivatives such as antibody fragments,
fragment fusions, proteins, peptides, peptide mimetics, organic molecules, dyes, fluoresencent
molecules, and enzyme substrates.
[0535] In a preferred embodiment the T
T being an organic molecule has a molecular weight of less than 2000 Da, more preferably
less than 1500 Da, more preferably less than 1000 Da, even more preferably less than
500 Da.
[0536] In another preferred embodiment the T
T is selected from antibody fragments, fragment fusions, and other antibody derivatives
that do not contain a Fc domain.
[0537] In another embodiment the T
T is a polymer. Typical polymers used in this embodiment include but are not limited
to polyethyleneglycol (PEG), poly(N-(2-hydroxypropyl)methacrylamide) (HPMA), polylactic
acid (PLA), polylactic-glycolic acid (PLGA), polyglutamic acid (PG), polyvinylpyrrolidone
(PVP), poly(1-hydroxymethylethylene hydroxymethyl-formal (PHF). Other examples are
copolymers of a polyacetal/polyketal and a hydrophilic polymer selected from the group
consisting of polyacrylates, polyvinyl polymers, polyesters, polyorthoesters, polyamides,
oligopeptides, polypeptides and derivatives thereof. Other examples are oligopeptides,
polypeptides, glycopolysaccharides, and polysaccharides such as dextran and hyaluronan,
In addition reference is made to [
G. Pasut, F.M. Veronese, Prog. Polym. Sci. 2007, 32, 933-961]. In preferred embodiments the T
T being a polymer accumulates at the Primary Target by virtue of the EPR effect.
[0538] According to a further particular embodiment of the invention, the Primary Target
and Targeting Agent are selected so as to result in the specific or increased targeting
of a tissue or disease, such as cancer, an inflammation, an infection, a cardiovascular
disease, e.g. thrombus, atherosclerotic lesion, hypoxic site, e.g. stroke, tumor,
cardiovascular disorder, brain disorder, apoptosis, angiogenesis, an organ, and reporter
gene/enzyme. This can be achieved by selecting Primary Targets with tissue-, cell-
or disease- specific expression. For example, the CC49 antibody targets TAG72, the
expression of which is limited in normal tissues, but receptors are overexpressed
in various solid tumor cell types.
[0539] As used herein, a T
T that "specifically binds or complexes with" or "targets" a cell surface molecule,
an extracellular matrix target, or another target, preferentially associates with
the target via intermolecular forces. For example, the ligand can preferentially associate
with the target with a dissociation constant (K
d or K
D) of less than 50 nM, less than 5 nM, or less than 500 pM.
[0540] In another embodiment the targeting agent T
T localizes in the target tissue by means of the EPR effect. An exemplary T
T for use in with the EPR effect is a polymer.
[0541] In preferred embodiments the targeting agent T
T localizes or has retention in a particular system, tissue, or organ in the body,
for example, blood circulation, lymphatic system, the nervous system, the digestion
system, RES system, or organs such as the heart or kidney. For example, microparticles
will localize in the liver, large hydrophilic polymers will have retention in circulation.
Likewise, use of an albumin binding moiety as T
T will result in prolonged retention in circulation.
[0542] In preferred embodiments, T
T is used to modify the pharmacokinetics of the moiety it is attached to. This can
include, but is not limited to, delaying the blood clearance of said moiety, affecting
the volume of distribution of said moiety (e.g. reducing or increasing the volume
of distribution), affecting the metabolism of said moiety, and/or affecting (preferably
avoiding) the sticking or uptake of said moiety to non-target tissues. Exemplary T
T's in this regard are polymer, peptide, peptoid, dendrimer, protein, carbohydrate,
oligonucleotide, oligosaccharide, lipid, liposome, micelle, nanoparticle, microparticle,
albumin, albumin-binding moiety, and small to medium sized organic molecules such
as steroids and dyes. Typically, a suitable polymer is polyethyleneglycol (PEG) or
polypropyleneglycol (PPG). Such suitable PEG includes PEG with a number of repeating
units in a range of from 2 to 4000, and PEG with a molecular weight in a range of
from 200 Da to 100,000 Da.
[0543] In preferred embodiments, when a T
T is an Administration Agent, it equals C
B.
R32
[0544] R
32 is a conjugation moiety, which is a chemical group that can be used for binding,
conjugation or coupling to
e.g. a Label, Administration Agent, Construct C, R
98, L
A, L
B, S
L, S
P, and L
C. The person skilled in the art is aware of the myriad of strategies that are available
for the chemoselective or -unselective or enzymatic coupling or conjugation of one
molecule or construct to another.
[0546] In particularly favourable embodiments, R
32 is selected from the group consisting of N-maleimidyl groups, halogenated N-alkylamido
groups, sulfonyloxy N-alkylamido groups, vinyl sulfone groups, activated carboxylic
acids, benzenesulfonyl halides, ester groups, carbonate groups, sulfonyl halide groups,
thiol groups or derivatives thereof, C
2-6 alkenyl groups, C
2-6 alkynyl groups, C
7-18 cycloalkynyl groups, C
5-18 heterocycloalkynyl groups, bicyclo[6.1.0]non-4-yn-9-yl] groups, C
3-12 cycloalkenyl groups, azido groups, phosphine groups, nitrile oxide groups, nitrone
groups, nitrile imine groups, isonitrile groups, diazo groups, ketone groups, (O-alkyl)hydroxylamino
groups, hydrazine groups, halogenated N-maleimidyl groups , aryloxymaleimides, dithiophenolmaleimides,
bromo- and dibromopyridazinediones, 2,5-dibromohexanediamide groups, alkynone groups,
3-arylpropiolonitrile groups, 1,1-bis(sulfonylmethyl)-methylcarbonyl groups or elimination
derivatives thereof, carbonyl halide groups, allenamide groups, 1,2-quinone groups,
isocyanate groups, isothiocyanate groups, aldehyde groups, triazine groups, squaric
acids, 2-imino-2-methoxyethyl groups, (oxa)norbornene groups, (imino)sydnones, methylsulfonyl
phenyloxadiazole groups, aminooxy groups, 2-amino benzamidoxime groups, ethynylphosphonamidates,
groups reactive in the Pictet- Spengler ligation and hydrazino- Pictet- Spengler (HIPS)
ligation, DNA intercalator, tetrazine groups, and photocrosslinkers.
[0547] In preferred embodiments, R
32 is an N-maleimidyl group connected to the remaining part of the compound according
to Formula (20) via the N atom of the N-maleimidyl group. In other preferred embodiments
R
32 is selected from the group consisting of, hydroxyl groups, amine groups, halogens,
vinyl pyridine groups, disulfide groups, pyridyl disulfide groups, sulfonyloxy groups,
mercaptoacetamide groups, anhydride groups, sulfonylated hydroxyacetamido groups,
sulfonyl chlorides, thiosemicarbazone, hydrazine carboxylate, and arylhydrazide.
[0548] In other embodiments R
32 is group that can be connected to another group by means of an enzyme, for example
sortase or Tubulin tyrosine ligase.
R'
[0549] In preferred embodiments, each R' is independently selected from the group consisting
of hydrogen, C
1-C
6 alkylene groups, C
2-C
6 alkenylene groups, C
2-C
6 alkynylene groups, C
6 arylene, C
4-C
5 heteroarylene, C
3-C
6 cycloalkylene groups, C
5-C
8 cycloalkenylene groups, C
5-C
12 alkyl(hetero)arylene groups, C
5-C
12 (hetero)arylalkylene groups, C
4-C
12 alkylcycloalkylene groups, and C
4-C
12 cycloalkylalkylene groups.
[0550] In preferred embodiments, each R' is independently selected from the group consisting
of hydrogen, C
1-C
4 alkylene groups, C
2-C
4 alkenylene groups, C
2-C
4 alkynylene groups, C
6 arylene, C
4-C
5 heteroarylene, C
3-C
6 cycloalkylene groups, C
5-C
8 cycloalkenylene groups, C
5-C
8 alkyl(hetero)arylene groups, C
5-C
8 (hetero)arylalkylene groups, C
4-C
12 alkylcycloalkylene groups, and C
4-C
8 cycloalkylalkylene groups.
[0551] Unless stated otherwise, for R' the alkylene groups, alkenylene groups, alkynylene
groups, (hetero)arylene groups, cycloalkylene groups, cycloalkenylene groups, alkyl(hetero)arylene
groups, (hetero)arylalkylene groups, alkylcycloalkylene groups, cycloalkylalkylene
groups are optionally substituted with a moiety selected from the group consisting
of -Cl, -F, -Br, -I, -OH, -NH
2, =O, -SH, -SO
3H, -PO
3H, -PO
4H
2, -NO
2, and optionally contain one or more heteroatoms selected from the group consisting
of -O-, -S-, -NH-, -P-, and -Si, wherein the N, S, and P atoms are optionally oxidized.
Medical use and non-therapeutic methods
[0552] In the following, the references to methods of treatment by therapy or in vivo diagnosis
methods are to be interpreted as references to compounds and medicaments of the present
invention for use in those methods.
Therapeutic use
[0553] In one aspect, the invention relates to a compound, a combination, or a kit of the
invention for use as a medicament. Alternatively, the kits of the invention are used
in a method for treating or imaging patients, said method comprising administering
the compounds comprised in the kits of the invention to a subject.
[0554] In another aspect, the invention pertains to a compound, a combination, or a kit
of the invention for use in the treatment of a disease, preferably cancer, in a subject,
preferably a human. Preferably, the treatment is radiotherapy.
[0555] Preferably, the radiotherapy comprises the steps of
- (a) administering a compound according to Formula (1) as defined herein, to the subject;
- (b) administering a Cleaving Agent as defined herein, to said subject;
- (c) irradiating the compound according to Formula (1) present in the subject.
[0556] The disclosure also pertains to a method of treatment in a subject as defined herein,
said method comprising the steps (a)-(c) as defined in the preceding paragraph. Preferably,
the method is for treating cancer in said subject.
[0557] In a preferred embodiment, step (a) is carried out first, secondly step (b) is carried
out, and then step (c). In that embodiment, preferably step (b) is carried out after
waiting a sufficient amount of time after step (a), so that a significant part, preferably
at least 10%, more preferably at least 50 % of what is maximally achievable, of the
dose of a compound according to Formula (1) has reached the target. Preferably, the
Cleaving Agent and/or its dose are chosen in this embodiment so as to ensure that
compound according to Formula (1) that has reached the target is not cleaved in significant
amounts, preferably less than 30 % , more preferably less than 10%. In such a way,
in step (b) the target-to-background ratio of the radionuclide can be optimized before
irradiation in step (c). Preferably, in this embodiment a further step (b) is carried
out after step (c) so as to quickly reduce the amount of radionuclides in the subject
after irradiation.
[0558] In another embodiment, step (a) is carried out first, secondly step (c) is carried
out, and then step (b). In this way, the amount of radionuclides in the subject can
be quickly reduced after irradiation to minimize the radiation dose received by non-target
tissues.
[0559] In another embodiment, step (b) is carried out first, allowing the Cleaving Agent
to accumulate in non-target tissue that needs protecting from the radiation; secondly
step (a) is carried out, affording the targeting of the radiation to target tissue,
while the Label is cleaved and removed in non-target tissue by the pre-localized Cleaving
Agent; and then step (c) takes place.
[0560] Likewise, the Cleaving Agent can be locally administered, i.e. directly injected,
into tissues that need protecting, as opposed to a systemic intravenous administration.
[0561] One prominent application of the invention, is radioimmunotherapy targeted to an
internalizing cancer receptor such as HER2. In this approach the HER2-targeting antibody
Trastuzumab (Tmab) is modified with, for example three TCO-chelate constructs as shown
below. The TCO-chelate construct (NHS-TCO-DOTA) comprises an active ester for lysine
conjugation, the TCO linker, and a DOTA chelate for
117Lu labeling, a therapeutic beta emitter. Following
117Lu- labeling of Tmab and intravenous (i.v.) injection, the
117Lu-Tmab is allowed to circulate, bind the HER2 target on the breast cancer or ovarian
cancer sites, allowed time to internalize (ca 2 days) after which the tetrazine comprising
Cleaving Agent is intravenously injected, which cleaves
117Lu-DOTA construct from the freely circulating Tmab, resulting in rapid clearance of
117Lu-DOTA construct via the kidney, and a vast reduction of radiation dose to the bone
marrow. Typically the Cleaving Agent is hydrophilic and as a result non cell permeable
and will therefore not cleave the
117Lu-Tmab inside the target cell. However, even if the Cleaving Agent is cell permeable
and cleaves
117Lu-Tmab inside the target cell, typically the released
117Lu-DOTA will remain trapped inside the cell.

[0562] Also non-internalizing cancer receptors can be used as Primary Targets in above examples
if the Cleaving Agent is designed to have a low or slow uptake in the tumor. For example,
the Cleaving Agent can comprise a biodegradable PLGA particle core of ca 500 nm diameter,
modified with tetrazine moieties. Such a particle will exhibit rapid clearance from
blood by the liver, ensuring that it can only react with TCO containing constructs
in circulation, and does not accumulate in the tumor, as previously shown for tetrazine
clearing agents [
Rossin et al., J. Nucl. Med. 2013, 4, 11, 1989-1995; and
WO2012085789A1]. For imaging applications, slow accumulation at the target site may be acceptable,
in which case the tetrazine can be modified with an albumin binding moiety, or a protein
or a polymer such as a PEG, maximizing its retention in circulation, and thereby facilitating
its reaction with TCO constructs in circulation.
[0563] In one other preferred embodiment of this invention, the administration of the compound
of Formula (1) followed by the Cleaving agent allows to tune the blood circulation
and excretion pathway of the released Label.
[0564] In the context of
117Lu-Tmab RIT , after cell internalization a Cleaving Agent comprising, for example,
a tetrazine functionalized with a short polyethylene glycol (PEG) polymer is injected
and binds the TCO Trigger, resulting in the cleavage of the bond between the TCO and
the antibody. Subsequently the
177Lu-DOTA chelate carrying the PEG is released in circulation and due to the PEG it
clears via the kidneys.

[0565] In a similar approach, instead of a linear or branched polymer the Cleaving Agent
carries one or more functional groups that influence the clearance pathway of the
released moiety. For instance, a Cleaving Agent comprising a tetrazine and several
galactose groups will produce a released moiety that binds the Ashwell receptor in
hepatocytes, therefore resulting in fast hepatobiliary clearance of the label.
[0566] In another preferred embodiment of this invention, the Administration Agent is an
antibody fragment carrying an imageable or therapeutic radiometal chelate that accumulates
specifically in a tumor or another diseased tissue and internalizes into target cells,
but is also non-specifically retained in non-target organs such as, but not restricted
to, kidneys, salivary glands and lacrimal glands. In this approach the Label (e.g.
177Lu or
225Ac labeled DOTA or
89Zr labeled DFO) is linked to the targeting moiety via a TCO trigger. After i.v. injection
of the compound of Formula (1) and after such Agent has accumulated in the diseased
tissue and internalized into target cells (e.g. 4 to 24h post-injection), the patient
in administered a Cleaving Agent intravenously. The Cleaving Agent specifically binds
the TCO trigger on the Administration Agent in non-target organs and releases the
Label thus inducing radioactivity wash out from these organs via the urine. This reduces
the radioactive dose delivered to non-target organs thus increasing the therapeutic
index of Administration Agents object of this invention and reducing the chance of
toxic side effects for the patient in nuclear imaging procedures.
[0567] In another preferred embodiment of this invention the compound of Formula (1) is
functionalized on both allylic positions. The compound of Formula (1)is injected i.v.
in an animal or human subject and is followed, after a suitable time (e.g. 2 days),
by i.v. injection of the Cleaving Agent which specifically reacts with the Trigger
resulting in the release of at least one of the two moieties conjugated in TCO allylic
position. This approach allows the very fast and complete release of a small fragment
(e.g. a Label) that will rapidly clear from non target tissues, preferentially via
the kidney, regardless of the pyridazine tautomer (either the 1,4 or 2,5) formed after
reaction of the TCO Trigger and the tetrazine Cleaving Agent. For very fast and complete
release it is preferred that the tetrazine is according to Formula (14), with Y
a being Y
1, Y
3, or Y
5 with Q
1 being X
45, preferably X
45 being OH, and Y
b being identical to Y
a or H. One non limiting example of this approach is shown below for a
177Lu-labeled mAb

[0568] In yet another preferred embodiment of this invention the compound of Formula (1)
comprises a TCO Trigger conjugated Targeting Agent and to an imaging or therapeutic
moiety (Label) via a self-immolative linker. The compound of Formula (1) is injected
i.v. in an animal or human subject, it accumulates at the target site and, after a
suitable time (e.g. one or two days) is followed by i.v. injection of a tetrazine
Cleaving Agent. The tetrazine reacts with the Trigger resulting in an intermediate
that rearranges electronically resulting in the fragmentation of the linker and the
detachment of the Label from the Targeting Agent. As a result the Label, being a small
molecule, rapidly clears from the subject's circulation, preferentially via the kidney.
A non limiting example of this invention is shown below

[0569] In one other preferred embodiment of this invention the compound of Formula (1) comprises
an imageable or therapeutic moiety bound via a TCO Trigger to a Targeting Agent that
binds a specific receptor or molecule present both at a disease site and in circulation
due to shedding. Non limiting examples of shedding targets are the carcinoembryonic
antigen (CEA), the prostate specific antigen (PSA), and the tumor necrosis factor
α (TNF-α) receptor. In the presence of target shedding, Administration Agent binding
to circulating target is detrimental as it causes loss of image contrast and/or toxic
side effects in the subject of the medical intervention. With the approach of this
invention, the compound of Formula (1) is injected i.v. in an animal or human subject
and binds to its target at the disease site and in circulation. After a suitable time
(one or two days) the subject is injected the tetrazine Cleaving Agent i.v. which
is designed to specifically react with the TCO Trigger on the circulating (bound)
Administration Agent. Upon reaction between the tetrazine and the TCO, the imageable
or therapeutic moiety is released from the Administration Agent and it clears rapidly
from circulation.
[0570] In one preferred embodiment, the invention is used to reduce the kidney dose instead
of the bone marrow dose. In this embodiment, the Administration Agent being an intact
IgG antibody is labeled with
225Ac and allowed to bind its Primary Target, such as HER2, PSMA.
225Ac has a chain of daughter isotopes, and upon the 1
st decay of
225Ac, the nuclide is separated from the DOTA and the Administration Agent resulting
in renal uptake of the free daughter
221Fr. Timely injection of the Cleaving Agent results cleavage in blood and rapid elimination
of DOTA-
225Ac via the kidneys and reduced
221Fr radiation dose to the kidneys.
[0571] In another embodiment, the Primary Target is a receptor on a blood cancer cell, i.e.
CD33 on AML cells, and the Administration Agent is antiCD33 mAb, and the Label is
DOTA-
225Ac. After CD33 binding and internalization, the DOTA-
225Ac Label of the freely circulating mAb in cleaved to reduce the radiation toxicity
to kidneys, and also the bone marrow, liver, and spleen.
[0572] Furthermore, the disclosure pertains to a diagnostic method comprising the steps
of
- (a) administering a compound according to Formula (1) as defined herein, to a subject,
preferably a human;
- (b) administering a Cleaving Agent as defined herein, to said subject;
- (c) imaging the compound according to Formula (1) present in the subject to collect
data;
- (d) comparing said data to standard values;
- (e) finding a significant deviation from said standard values during comparison;
- (f) attributing the significant deviation to a particular clinical picture, preferably
to cancer.
Diagnostic method
[0573] The invention also pertains to a compound of Formula (1) as defined herein, a combination
as defined herein, or a kit as defined herein for use in a diagnostic method comprising
the steps of
- (a) administering a compound according to Formula (1) as defined herein, to a subject,
preferably a human;
- (b) administering a Cleaving Agent as defined herein, to said subject;
- (c) imaging the compound according to Formula (1) present in the subject to collect
data;
- (d) comparing said data to standard values;
- (e) finding a significant deviation from said standard values during comparison;
- (f) attributing the significant deviation to a particular clinical picture, preferably
to cancer.
Non-therapeutic method
[0574] The invention also pertains to a non-therapeutic method for imaging a compound of
Formula (1) as defined herein, in a subject as defined herein, preferably a human,
said non-therapeutic method comprising the steps of
- (a) administering a compound according to Formula (1) as defined herein, to the subject;
- (b) administering a Cleaving Agent as defined herein, to said subject;
- (c) imaging the compound according to Formula (1) present in the subject.
[0575] In a preferred embodiment, step (a) is carried out first, secondly step (b) is carried
out, and then step (c). In that embodiment, preferably step (b) is carried out after
waiting a sufficient amount of time after step (a), so that a significant part, preferably
at least 10%, more preferably at least 50 % of what is maximally achievable, of the
of the initial dose of a compound according to Formula (1) has reached the target.
Preferably, the Cleaving Agent and/or its dose are chosen in this embodiment so as
to ensure that compound according to Formula (1) that has reached the target is not
cleaved in significant amounts, preferably less than 30 %, more preferably less than
10%. In such a way, in step (b) the target-to-background ratio of the radionuclide
can be optimized before imaging in step (c).
[0576] Preferably, in this embodiment a further step (b) is carried out after step (c) so
as to quickly reduce the amount of radionuclides in the subject after imaging.
[0577] In another embodiment, step (a) is carried out first, secondly step (c) is carried
out, and then step (b). In this way, the amount of radionuclides in the subject can
be quickly reduced after imaging, to reduce whole body radiation dose and / or optionally
to allow for another imaging procedure (image cycling).
[0578] In another embodiment, step (b) is carried out first, allowing the Cleaving Agent
to accumulate in non-target tissue that needs protecting from the radiation or that
would otherwise obscure imaging of the Primary Target; secondly step (a) is carried
out, affording the targeting of the radiation to target tissue, while the Label is
cleaved and removed in non-target tissue by the pre-localized Cleaving Agent; and
then step (c) takes place.
[0579] Likewise, the Cleaving Agent can be locally administered, i.e. directly injected,
into selected non-target tissues, as opposed to a systemic i.v. administration.
[0580] The invention can be used to improve radioimmunoimaging of HER2 with Trastuzumab
(Tmab). In this approach Tmab is modified with for example 2 TCO-DFO chelate constructs,
as shown below, wherein the Tmab is conjugated via thiol maleimide chemistry. Following
89Zr-labeling of Tmab and intravenous (i.v.) injection, the
89Zr -Tmab is allowed to circulate, bind the HER2 target on the breast cancer or ovarian
cancer sites, allowed time to internalize (ca 2 days) after which the tetrazine comprising
Cleaving Agent is i.v. injected, which cleaves the
89Zr -DFO label from the freely circulating Tmab, resulting in rapid clearance of
89Zr -DFO construct via the kidney, and a vast improvement tumor-blood ratio in imaging
of the target.

[0581] In a similar approach as with the above HER2 imaging example, the invention can be
used in companion imaging of antibody drugs that are being developed to cross the
blood brain barrier (BBB) to treat, for example, Alzheimer's disease. In such an approach
the therapeutic antibody can be modified with an additional domain which binds to
the transferrin receptor, resulting in crossing of the BBB. As only a minor amount
will cross the BBB and bind to its Primary Target, and as a large amount will still
freely circulate in blood, conventional imaging approaches (e.g. by labeling the antibody
with
89Zr) is hampered by very poor target-non-target (T-NT) ratios. Conjugation of the cleavable
DFO-TCO-maleimide construct shown above to the anti-Alzheimer antibody, labeling with
89Zr, i.v. injection, followed by some time for target uptake will allow the cleavage
of freely circulating
89Zr-antibody at desired time points, making the circulating antibody essentially invisible,
while retaining the
89Zr-signal at the target site, boosting T-NT ratios. This approach also allows discriminating
between
89Zr-antibody that has crossed the BBB and the portion that has bound in the brain but
has not crossed the BBB, or where the BBB is impaired. In this embodiment, the diene
is preferably designed such that it does extravasate, but does not significantly permeate
the BBB. In another preferred embodiment, the diene is designed such that it does
not extravasate into other tissues.
Administration
[0582] When administering the compound of Formula (1) and the Cleaving Agent to a subject,
such as an animal or human, in preferred embodiments the compound of Formula (1) is
administered first. It will take a certain time period before the the compound of
Formula (1) has reached the Primary Target, and optionally internalized in the cell
or crossed the blood brain barrier. This time period may differ from one application
to the other and may be for example minutes or hours.
[0583] After the time period of choice has elapsed, the Cleaving Agent is administered,
which reacts with the the compound of Formula (1) to decouple the Administration Agent
and the Label, preferably in the non-target tissues. In some preferred embodiments,
the time interval between the administration of the compound of Formula (1) and the
Cleaving Agent is between 10 minutes and 4 weeks. In some preferred embodiments, the
time interval between the administration of the compound of Formula (1) and the Cleaving
Agent is between 1 hour and 2 weeks, preferably between 1 and 168 hours, more preferably
between 1 and 120 hours, even more preferably between 1 and 96 hours, more preferably
between 3 and 72 hours, more preferably still between 4 and 48 hours, and most preferably
between 5 and 24 hours.
[0584] The compounds and the combinations of the invention can be administered via different
routes including but not limited to intravenous or subcutaneous injection, intraperitoneal,
local injection, oral administration, rectal administration and inhalation. Formulations
suitable for these different types of administrations are known to the skilled person.
Compounds of Formula (1) or Cleaving Agents according to the invention can be administered
together with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. A suitable pharmaceutical carrier
as used herein relates to a carrier suitable for medical or veterinary purposes, not
being toxic or otherwise unacceptable. Such carriers are well known in the art and
include for example saline, buffered saline, dextrose, water, glycerol, ethanol, and
combinations thereof. The formulation should suit the mode of administration.
[0585] It will be understood that the chemical entities administered, viz. the compound
of Formula (1) and the Cleaving Agent, can be in a modified form that does not alter
the chemical functionality of said chemical entity, such as salts, hydrates, or solvates
thereof.
[0586] In preferred embodiments, the Cleaving Agent, preferably comprising a Targeting Agent,
is administered first, and thereafter the compound of Formula (1) is administered.
[0587] Preferably, in embodiments where the compound of Formula (1) and the Cleaving Agent
are administered approximately simultaneously, they are administered via different
routes.
Subject
[0588] As used herein, "subject" means any animal, preferably a mammal, most preferably
a human. The term "mammal" as used herein, encompasses any mammal. Examples of mammals
include, but are not limited to, cows, horses, sheep, pigs, cats, dogs, mice, rats,
rabbits, guinea pigs, non-human primates (NHPs) such as monkeys or apes, humans, etc.,
more preferably a human.
Non-therapeutic use
[0589] The invention also pertains to a use of a compound of Formula (1) as defined herein,
a combination as defined herein, or a kit as defined herein, for imaging in a subject,
preferably a human.
Examples
General methods
[0590] All reagents, chemicals, materials and solvents were obtained from commercial sources
and were used as received, including nitrile starting compounds that not have been
described. All solvents were of AR quality. Sodium [
125I]iodide, [
111In]Indium and [
177Lu]lutetium chloride, and [
89Zr]zirconium oxalate solutions were purchased from PerkinElmer, Curium and IDB. Zeba
desalting spin columns (7 and 40 kDa MW cut-off, 0.5 mL) and Slide-A-Lyzer dialysis
cassettes (20 kDa MW cut-off) were purchased from Pierce Protein Research (Thermo
Fisher Scientific). Mouse plasma was purchased from Innovative Research. 29-Amino-3,6,9,12,15,18,21,24,27-nonaoxanonacosan-1-ol
was purchased from PurePEG. 3,6-Dimethyl-1,2,4,5-tetrazine and (
E)-cyclooct-2-en-1-yl (4-nitrophenyl) carbonate were prepared according to literature
procedures [
Versteegen et al., Angew. Chem. Int. Ed. 2013, 52, 14112-14116]. Analytical thin layer chromatography was performed on Kieselgel F-254 precoated
silica plates. Column chromatography was carried out on Screening Devices B.V. silica
gel (flash: 40-63 pm mesh and normal: 60-200 pm mesh).
1H-NMR and
13C-NMR spectra were recorded on a Bruker Avance III HD (400 MHz for
1H-NMR and 100 MHz for
13C-NMR) spectrometer at 298 K. Chemical shifts are reported in ppm downfield from TMS
at rt. Abbreviations used for splitting patterns are s = singlet, d = doublet, dd
= double doublet, t = triplet, q = quartet, m = multiplet and br = broad. HPLC-PDA/MS
was performed using a Shimadzu LC-10 AD VP series HPLC coupled to a diode array detector
(Finnigan Surveyor PDA Plus detector, Thermo Electron Corporation) and an Ion-Trap
(LCQ Fleet, Thermo Scientific). HPLC-analyses were performed using a Alltech Alltima
HP C
18 3p column using an injection volume of 1-4 µL, a flow rate of 0.2 mL min
-1 and typically a gradient (5 % to 100 % in 10 min, held at 100 % for a further 3 min)
of MeCN in H
2O (both containing 0.1 % formic acid) at 298 K. Size exclusion chromatography (SEC)
was performed on an Akta system (GE Healthcare Life Science) equipped with a Superdex200
column. Radio-HPLC was performed on an Agilent 1100 system, equipped with a Gabi radioactive
detector (Raytest). The samples were loaded on an Alltima C18 column (4.6 × 150mm,
5p), which was eluted at 1 mL min-1 with a linear gradient of water (A) and acetonitrile
(B) containing 0.1% v/v% TFA (4 min at 3% B followed by an increase to 90% B in 15
min). Radio-ITLC was performed on ITLC-SG strips (Varian Inc.) eluted with 200 mM
EDTA in saline solution (
111In/
177Lu) or in 0.1M citrate pH 6.0 (
89Zr). In these conditions the radiolabeled products remain at the base while unbound
radionuclide migrates with a R
f of 0.7-0.9. SDS-PAGE was performed on a Mini-PROTEAN Tetra Cell system using 4-20%
precast Mini-PROTEAN TGX gels and Precision Plus Protein All Blue Prestained protein
standards (BioRad Laboratories). The radioactivity distribution on ITLC strips and
SDS-PAGE gels was monitored with a Typhoon FLA 7000 phosphor imager (GE Healthcare
Life Science) using the AIDA software.
Example 1: Synthesis of conjugatable TCO-DOTA constructs
Compound 1.1 (axial isomer) was prepared according to a published method
[Rossin et al., Bioconjugate Chem. 2016, 27, 1697-1706]
[0591]

NHS-TCO-PEG4-DOTAGA (1.2)
[0592]

[0593] A solution of 4-[(14-amino-3,6,9,12-tetraoxatetradecan-1-yl)carbamoyl]-2-[4,7,10-tris(carboxymethyl)-1,4,7,10-tetraazacyclododecan-1-yl]butanoic
acid HCl salt (18.0 mg, 25.9 µmol) and DiPEA (50.2 µL, 288 µmol) in H
2O was added to a solution of
1.1 (12.2 mg, 28.8 µmol) in acetonitrile and the solution was stirred for 5 min. The
reaction mixture was acidified followed by preparative RP-HPLC purification using
an elution gradient of 5 % to 90 % MeCN in H
2O (both containing 0.1 % TFA) to yield compound
1.2 (10.0 mg, 9.98 µg, 39%) after lyophilization as a fluffy white powder.
1H NMR (400 MHz, CD
3OD): δ 5.92-5.99 (m, 1H), 5.72 (d, J = 16.8 Hz, 1H), 5.12 (bs, 1H), 4.08-4.25 (m,
2H), 4.07-3.96 (m, 1H) 3.78-3.94 (bs, 2H), 3.61-3.67 (m, 11H), 3.53-3.57 (m, 6H),
3.35 (m, 2H), 3.10-3.25 (bs, 4H), 2.90-3.05 (m, 2H), 2.78-2.85 (s, 4H) 2.62-2.72 (m,
1H), 2.50-2.59 (m, 1H), 2.24-2.40 (m, 2H), 2.13-2.20 (m, 10H), 2.02-2.10 (3H), 1.90-2.02
(m, 3H), 1.30 (s, 3H), 1.27 (bs, 2H) ppm. ESI-MS: m/z calc for C
44H
71N
7O
19 1001.48; Obs. [M+H]
+ 1002.40, [M+2H]
+ 501.36.
Mal-PEG2-TCO-PEG4-DOTAGA (1.3)
[0594]

[0595] Commercially available tert-butyl N-(2-{2-[2-(2,5-dioxo-2,5-dihydro-1H-pyrrol-1-yl)ethoxy]ethoxy}ethyl)carbamate
(3.3 mg, 9.98 µmol) was treated with CHCl
3:TFA (1:1) for 20 min at rt before removal of the volatiles. The resulting species
was dissolved in CH
2Cl
2 and added drop wise to a solution of
1.2 (10.0 mg, 9.98 µmol) and DiPEA (17.4 µL, 99.8 µmol) in CH
2Cl
2 and the reaction was stirred for 15 min at rt. Following acidification and removal
of the volatiles, preparative RP-HPLC purification using an elution gradient of 5
% to 90 % MeCN in H
2O (both containing 0.1 % TFA) yielded compound
1.3 after lyophilization as a fluffy white powder.
NHS-TCO-C2-DOTAGA (1.4)
[0596]

[0597] A solution of 4-[(2-aminoethyl)carbamoyl]-2-[4,7,10-tris(carboxymethyl)-1,4,7,10-tetraazacyclododecan-1-yl]butanoic
acid (13.4 mg, 25.9 µmol) and DiPEA (50.2 µL, 288 µmol) in H
2O was added to a solution of
1.1 (12.2 mg, 28.8 µmol) in acetonitrile and the solution was stirred for 5 min. Acidification
of the reaction mixture was followed by preparative RP-HPLC purification using an
elution gradient of 5 % to 90 % MeCN in H
2O (both containing 0.1 % TFA) to yield compound
1.4 (5.0 mg, 6.1 µg, 23%) after lyophilization as a fluffy white powder. ESI-MS: m/z
calc for C
36H
55N
7O
15 825.38; Obs. [M+H]
+ 826.24, Obs. [M+2H]
+ 413.24.
2-[({[(1S,2E,6S)-6-{[(2,5-Dioxopyrrolidin-1-yl)oxy]carbonyl}-6-methylcyclooct-2-en-1-yl]
oxy}carbonyl)(methyl)amino] acetic acid (1.5)
[0598]

[0599] A solution of sarcosine (5.8 mg, 64.9 µmol) and DiPEA (20.6 µL, 118 µmol) in H
2O was added to a solution of
1.1 (25 mg, 59 µmol) in MeCN and the mixture was acidified after 5 min. Following removal
of MeCN in vacuo, dilution with H
2O and extraction with CHCl
3 (3x20 mL), followed by drying over Na
2SO
4 and concentration yielded
1.5 in ca. 90% purity (20 mg, 50.7 µmol, 86%). ESI-MS: m/z calc for C
18H
24N
2O
8 396.15; Obs. [M-H]- 395.16, Obs. [2M-H]- 791.12.
NHS-TCO-Sar-C2-DOTAGA (1.6)
[0600]

[0601] PyBOP (10 mg, 19.2 µmol) and DiPEA (14 µL, 80.4 µmol) were added to a solution of
1.5 (12 mg, ca. 27 µmol) in MeCN and the reaction mixture was stirred for 10 min. A solution
of 4-[(2-aminoethyl)carbamoyl]-2-[4,7,10-tris(carboxymethyl)-1,4,7,10-tetraazacyclododecan-1-yl]butanoic
acid (10.4 mg, 20.1 µmol) and DiPEA (21 µL, 120.6 µmol) in H
2O was added and the solution was stirred for 5 min. Acidification of the reaction
mixture was followed by preparative RP-HPLC purification using an elution gradient
of 5 % to 90 % MeCN in H
2O (both containing 0.1 % TFA) to yield compound
1.6 (12.5 mg, 13.9 µg, 73%) after lyophilization as a fluffy white powder. ESI-MS: m/z
calc for C
39H
60N
8O
16 896.41; Obs. [M+H]
+ 897.48, Obs. [M+2H]
+ 448.96.
NHS-TCO-Sar-PEG4-DOTAGA (1.7)
[0602]

[0603] PyBOP (12.7 mg, 24.3 µmol) and DiPEA (14 µL, 80.4 µmol) were added to a solution
of
1.5 (12 mg, ca. 27 µmol) in MeCN and the reaction mixture was stirred for 10 min. A solution
of 4-[(14-amino-3,6,9,12-tetraoxatetradecan-1-yl)carbamoyl]-2-[4,7,10-tris(carboxymethyl)-1,4,7,10-tetraazacyclododecan-1-yl]butanoic
acid HCl salt (18.8 mg, 27 µmol) and DiPEA (21 µL, 120.6 µmol) in H
2O was added and the solution was stirred for 5 min. Acidification of the reaction
mixture was followed by preparative RP-HPLC purification using an elution gradient
of 5 % to 90 % MeCN in H
2O (both containing 0.1 % TFA) to yield compound
1.7 (19.5 mg, 18.2 µg, 75%) after lyophilization as a fluffy white powder. ESI-MS: m/z
calc for C
47H
76N
8O
20 1072.52; Obs. [M+H]
+ 1073.68, Obs. [M+2H]
+ 537.08.
Mal-PEG9-TCO-Sar-PEG4-DOTAGA (1.8)
[0604]

[0605] Compound
1.7 (15 mg, 14.0 µmol) was treated with commercially available N-(29-amino-3,6,9,12,15,18,21,24,27-nonaoxanonacosan-1-yl)-3-(2,5-dioxo-2,5-dihydro-1H-pyrrol-1-yl)propanamide
TFA salt (12.2 mg, 16.9 µmol) and DiPEA (17 µL, 98.1 µmol) in DMF for 6 days at rt.
Acidification and concentration of the reaction mixture was followed by preparative
RP-HPLC purification using an elution gradient of 5 % to 90 % MeCN in H
2O (both containing 0.1 % TFA) to yield compound
1.8 (3.5 mg, 2.2 µg, 16%) after lyophilization as a sticky oil. ESI-MS: m/z calc for
C
70H
120N
10O
29 1564.82; Obs. [M+H]
+ 1565.80 Obs. [M-H]- 1564.32.
NHS-TCO-PEG4-BCN (1.9)
[0606]

[0607] Compound
1.1 (35 mg, 83 µmol) was treated with commercially available [(1R,8S,9R)-bicyclo[6.1.0]non-4-yn-9-yl]methyl
N-{2-[2-(2-aminoethoxy)ethoxy]ethyl}carbamate (29.9 mg, 92.1 µmol) and DiPEA (28.9
µL, 166 µmol) in CH
2Cl
2 for 45 min prior to concentration. Compound
1.9 was isolated as a white fluffy powder after preparative RP-HPLC purification using
an elution gradient of 5 % to 90 % MeCN in H
2O (both containing 0.1 % TFA) (32 mg, 50.7 µg, 61%). ESI-MS: m/z calc for C
32H
45N
3O
10 631.31; Obs. [M+H]
+ 632.00, Obs. [2M+H
2O+H]
+ 1279.84.
4-{[2-(2-Azidoacetamido)ethyl]carbamoyl}-2-[4,7,10-tris(carboxymethyl)-1,4,7,10-tetraazacyclododecan-1-yl]butanoic
acid (1.10)
[0608]

[0609] A mixture of 4-[(2-aminoethyl)carbamoyl]-2-[4,7,10-tris(carboxymethyl)-1,4,7,10-tetraazacyclododecan-1-yl]butanoic
acid (24.8 mg, 47.8 µmol), 2,3,5,6-tetrafluorophenyl 2-azidoacetate (26.5 mg, 106.4
µmol) and DiPEA (50.4 µL, 289.3 µmol in MeCN/H
2O was stirred for 30 min at rt. Following acidification and concentration, preparative
RP-HPLC purification of 1/3
rd of the material using an elution gradient of 2 % to 10 % MeCN in H
2O (both containing 0.1 % TFA) yielded compound
1.10 (6.4 mg, 10.6 µg, 67%) after lyophilization as a white fluffy powder. ESI-MS: m/z
calc for C
23H
39N
9O
10 601.28; Obs. [M+H]
+ 602.32, Obs. [2M+H]
+ 301.60.
4-({14-[2-(Methylamino)acetamido]-3,6,9,12-tetraoxatetradecan-1-yl}carbamoyl)-2-[4,7,10-tris(carboxymethyl)-1,4,7,10-tetraazacyclododecan-1-yl]butanoic
acid TFA salt (1.11)
[0610]

[0611] Commercially available 2-{[(tert-butoxy)carbonyl](methyl)amino}acetic acid (6.0 mg,
31.6 µmol) was treated with PyBOP (7.1 mg, 13.7 µmol) and DiPEA (7.5 µL, 43.1 µL)
for 15 min in MeCN at rt. A solution of 4-[(14-amino-3,6,9,12-tetraoxatetradecan-1-yl)carbamoyl]-2-[4,7,10-tris(carboxymethyl)-1,4,7,10-tetraazacyclododecan-1-yl]butanoic
acid HCl salt (10 mg, 14.4 µmol) and DiPEA (15.1 µL, 86.4 µmol) in H
2O was added and the mixture was stirred for 30 min. Following concentration, the residue
was treated with CH
2Cl
2/TFA (1:1) for 30 min. Preparative RP-HPLC purification using an elution gradient
of 2 % to 10 % MeCN in H
2O (both containing 0.1 % TFA) yielded compound
1.11 (6.8 mg, 7.7 µg, 56%) after lyophilization. ESI-MS: m/z calc for C
32H
59N
7O
14 765.41; Obs. 766.60 [M+H]
+, Obs. [M+2H]
+ 383.88.
NHS-TCO-PEG22-CO2H (1.12)
[0612]

[0613] Compound
1.1 (15 mg, 35.1 µmol ) was treated with commercially available 68-amino-3,6,9,12,15,18,21,24,27,30,33,36,39,42,45,48,51,54,57,60,63,66-docosaoxaoctahexacontanoic
acid (Avg MW: 1100, n=~22, 39.1 mg, 35.5 µmol) and DiPEA (18.6 µL, 106.7 µmol) in
CH
2Cl
2 for 3 h. Following concentration, preparative RP-HPLC purification using an elution
gradient of 5 % to 95 % MeCN in H
2O (both containing 0.1 % TFA) yielded compound
1.12 (30 mg, 22.2 µg, 63%) after lyophilization as a sticky gum.
NHS-TCO-PEG22-C2-DOTAGA (1.13)
[0614]

[0615] PyBOP (11.1 mg, 17.9 µmol) and DiPEA (14.9 µL, 86.9 µmol) were added to a solution
of
1.12 (30 mg, ca. 22.2 µmol) in DMSO and the reaction mixture was stirred for 15 min. A
solution of 4-[(2-aminoethyl)carbamoyl]-2-[4,7,10-tris(carboxymethyl)-1,4,7,10-tetraazacyclododecan-1-yl]butanoic
acid (13.3 mg, 21.5 µmol) and DiPEA (22.3 µL, 128.9 µmol) in H
2O was added and the solution was stirred for 5 min. Acidification of the reaction
mixture was followed by preparative RP-HPLC purification using an elution gradient
of 5 % to 90 % MeCN in H
2O (both containing 0.1 % TFA) to yield compound
1.13 (6 mg, 3.2 µg, 15%) after lyophilization as a sticky gum.
NHS-TCO-DFO (1.14)
[0616]

[0617] A solution of commercially available desferrioxamine mesylate salt (29.9 mg, 42.6µmol)
and DiPEA (7.4 µL, 42.6 µmol) in DMSO was added to a solution of
1.1 (15 mg, 35.5 µmol) in DMSO and the solution was stirred for 4 h. The reaction mixture
was acidified followed by preparative RP-HPLC purification using an elution gradient
of 5% to 90% MeCN in H
2O (both containing 0.1 % TFA) to yield compound
1.14 (25.7 mg, 82%) after lyophilization as a fluffy white powder. ESI-MS: m/z calc for
C
41H
67N
7O
14 867.46; Obs [M+H]
+ 868.8.
1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.22 (s, 2H), 6.52 (s, 1H), 5.96-5.72 (m, 2H), 5.60 (d, 1H),
5.17 (d, 1H), 3.78 (t, 3H), 3.64 (s, 21H), 3.57 (d, 4H), 3.45-3.35 (m, 2H), 3.20 (s,
6H), 2.82 (s, 4H), 2.70-2.53 (m, 7H), 2.34-2.05 (m, 7H) ppm.
NHS-TCO-Sar-DFO (1.15)
[0618]

[0619] PyBOP (15.7 mg, 30.2 µmol) and DiPEA (10.5 µL, 60.4 µmol) were added to a solution
of
1.5 (12 mg, 30.2 µmol) in DMSO and the reaction mixture was stirred for 10 min. A solution
of desferrioxamine mesylate salt (21.8 mg, 33.2 µmol) and DiPEA (10.5 µL, 60.4 µmol)
in DMSO was added and the solution was stirred for 3 h. Acidification of the reaction
mixture was followed by preparative RP-HPLC purification using an elution gradient
of 5% to 90% MeCN in H
2O (both containing 0.1 % TFA) to yield compound
1.15 (18.2 mg, 64 %) after lyophilization as a fluffy white powder. ESI-MS: m/z calc for
C
43H
70N
8O
15 938.5; Obs. [M+H]
+ 939.2.
NHS-TCO-Sar-PEG4-CO2H (1.16)
[0620]

[0621] PyBOP (15.7 mg, 30.2 µmol) and DiPEA (10.5 µL, 60.4 µmol) were added to a solution
of
1.5 (12 mg, 30.2 µmol) in DMF and the reaction mixture was stirred for 10 min. A solution
of commercially available amino-PEG4-acid (9.6 mg, 36.2 µmol) and DiPEA (10.5 µL,
60.4 µmol) in DMF was added and the solution was stirred for 3 h. Acidification of
the reaction mixture was followed by preparative RP-HPLC purification using an elution
gradient of 5 % to 90 % MeCN in H
2O (both containing 0.1 % TFA) to yield compound
1.16 (12 mg, 62 %) after lyophilization as a sticky oil. ESI-MS: m/z calc for C
28H
43N
3O
13 643.3; Obs. [M+H]
+ 644.6.
NHS-TCO-Sar-PEG4-DFO (1.17)
[0622]

[0623] PyBOP (8.5 mg, 16.3 µmol) and DiPEA (5.6 µL, 32.6 µmol) were added to a solution
of
1.16 (10.5 mg, 16.3 µmol) in DMSO and the reaction mixture was stirred for 10 min. A solution
of desferrioxamine mesylate salt (11.6 mg, 17.9 µmol) and DiPEA (5.6 µL, 32.6 µmol)
in DMSO was added and the solution was stirred for 3 h. Acidification of the reaction
mixture was followed by preparative RP-HPLC purification using an elution gradient
of 5 % to 90 % MeCN in H
2O (both containing 0.1 % TFA) to yield compound
1.17 (13.2 mg, 68 %) after lyophilization as a fluffy white powder. ESI-MS: m/z calc for
C
54H
91N
9O
20 896.41; Obs. [M+H]
+1186.37, Obs. [M+2H]+ 1187.5.
Mal-PEG9-TCO-DFO (1.18)
[0624]

[0625] Compound
1.14 (15 mg, 17.3 µmol) was treated with commercially available mal-amido-PEG9-amine TFA
salt (11.5 mg, 19 µmol) and DiPEA (11.9 µL, 69.2 µmol) in DMF for 6 days at rt. Acidification
and concentration of the reaction mixture was followed by preparative RP-HPLC purification
using an elution gradient of 5 % to 90 % MeCN in H
2O (both containing 0.1 % TFA) to yield compound
1.18 (6.6 mg, 28%) after lyophilization as a sticky oil. ESI-MS: m/z calc for C
64H
111N
9O
23 1564.82; Obs. [M+H]
+ 1565.9.
(1R,4E)-Cyclooct-4-en-1-yl 2,5-dioxopyrrolidin-1-yl carbonate (1.19)
[0626]

[0627] (1R,4E)-Cyclooct-4-en-1-ol (TCO-5-OH, axial isomer) (0.20 g, 1.6 mmol) was treated
with DSC (0.81 g, 3.16 mmol), DMAP (0.22 g, 1.8 mmol) and DiPEA (1.4 mL, 4.9 mmol)
in dry MeCN for 16 h at rt. The reaction mixture was partitioned between EtOAc and
2M HCl followed by washing of the organics with saturated NaHCOs. After drying over
Na
2SO
4 and concentration, compound
1.19 was isolated after silica gel column chromatography (EtOAc / heptanes, 1:9 to 3:7).
Yield: 36% (0.15 g, 0.56 mmol).
3-({[(1R,4E)-Cyclooct-4-en-1-yloxy]carbonyl}amino)-2-sulfopropanoic acid (1.20)
[0628]

[0629] 1.19 (0.15g, 0.56 mmol) in MeCN was added to 3-amino-2-sulfopropanoic acid (0.14 g, 0.84
mmol) in sat. NaHCOs. After stirring for 1 h, the MeCN was removed in vacuo. Following
acidification, preparative HPLC (a H
2O/MeCN gradient with 0.1% TFA) and lyophilization,
1.20 was isolated in 74 % yield (0.13 g, 0.42 mmol). ESI-MS: m/z calc for C
12H
19NO
7S 321.09; Obs. [M-H]
+ 320.20.
1-({2-[2-(2-Aminoethoxy)ethoxy|ethyl}carbamoyl)-2-({[(1R,4E)-cyclooct-4-en-1-yloxy]carbonyl}amino)ethane-1-sulfonic
acid (1.21)
[0630]

[0631] PyBOP (0.28 g, 0.54 mmol) was added to a solution of
1.20 (0.13 g, 0.42 mmol) and amino-PEG
2-amine (2.47 g, 16.6 mmol) in MeCN and the reaction mixture was stirred for 1 h at
rt. Following acidification with aqueous citric acid, preparative HPLC (a H
2O/MeCN gradient with 0.1% TFA) and lyophilization,
1.21 was isolated in 71% yield (0.17 g, 0.30 mmol) as stick solid. ESI-MS: m/z calc for
C
18H
33N
3O
8S 451.20; Obs. [M+H]
+ 452.12.
Maleimide-TCO-TCO (1.22)
[0632]

[0633] 1.1 (10 mg, 22.6 µmol) was treated with the TFA salt of 1-{2-[2-(2-aminoethoxy) ethoxy]
ethyl}-2,5-dihydro-1H-pyrrole-2,5-dione (7.7 mg, 22.6 µmol), and DiPEA (11.9 µL, 67.8
µmol) in DMSO for 3 h.
1.21 (15.3 mg, 27.1 µmol) and DiPEA (11.9 µL, 67.8 µmol) were added and the reaction mixture
was stirred for 16 h at rt. Preparative HPLC (a H
2O/MeCN gradient with 0.1% TFA) and lyophilization, yielding
1.22 in 9.3 % yield (1.8 mg, 2.1 µmol). ESI-MS: m/z calc for C
39H
61N
5O
15S 871.39; Obs. [M+H]
+ 872.16.
Ethyl 2-hydroxy-2-[4-(methylamino)phenyl]acetate (1.23)
[0634]

[0635] Ethyl 2-(4-aminophenyl)-2-hydroxyacetate (1.5 g, 7.7 mmol) was treated with K
2CO
3 (5.3 g, 38.4 mmol) and MeI (0.6 mL, 9.6 mmol) under N
2 for 30 min in DMF (10 mL). H
2O (80 mL) was added followed by extraction with EtOAc (3×80 mL). The combined organics
were washed with brine (2×80 mL), dried over MgSO
4 and concentrated. Compound
1.23 was isolated after silica gel column chromatography (EtOAc / pentanes, 2:8 to 3:7).
Yield: 32% (0.51 g, 2.4 mmol). ESI-MS: m/z calc for C
11H
15NO
3 209.11; Obs. [M+H]
+ 210.08.
1H NMR (400 MHz, CD
3OD): δ 7.23 (d, J = 8.4 Hz, 2H), 6.60 (d, J = 8.6 Hz, 2H), 5.06 (s, 1H), 4.32-4.24
(m, 1H), 4.22-4.14 (m, 1H), 2.85 (s, 3H), 1.25 (t, J = 7.14 Hz) ppm.
2-Hydroxy-2-[4-(methylamino)phenyl]acetic acid (1.24)
[0636]

[0637] 10M NaOH (1 mL, 10 mmol) in H
2O was added to
1.23 (0.48 g, 2.3 mmol) in THF followed by stirring for 2 h at 40°C. Following acidification,
preparative HPLC (a H
2O/MeCN gradient with 0.1% TFA) and lyophilization, the TFA salt of
1.24 was isolated in 78% yield (0.52g, 1.76 mmol).
1H NMR (400 MHz, CD
3OD): δ 7.51 (d, J = 8.4 Hz, 2H), 7.39 (d, J = 8.6 Hz, 2H), 5.24 (s, 1H), 2.96 (s,
3H) ppm. NOESY (400 MHz, D
2O) confirmed the location of the methyl group to be at the anilinic amine.
2-[4-({[(1R,2E)-Cyclooct-2-en-1-yloxy]carbonyl}(methyl)amino) phenyl]-2-hydroxyacetic
acid (1.25)
[0638]

(1R,2E)-Cyclooct-2-en-1-yl 2,5-dioxopyrrolidin-1-yl carbonate (the axial isomer)
[0639] (0.11 g, 0.41 mmol) was treated with
1.24, DiPEA (0.29 mL, 1.65 mmol), and HOBt.H
2O (31.5 mg, 0.21 mmol) for 3 days in DMF at rt. Following preparative HPLC (a H
2O/MeCN gradient with 0.1% TFA) and lyophilization,
1.25 was isolated in 66% yield (91 mg, 0.27 mol). ESI-MS: m/z calc for C
18H
23NO
5 333.16; Obs. [M-H]
+ 332.12.
1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl
3): δ 7.42 (d, J = 8.4 Hz, 2H), 7.26 (d, J = 8.6 Hz, 2H), 6.04 (bs, 1H), 5.48 (d, J
= 16.0 Hz, 1H), 5.40 (bs, 1H), 5.18 (bs, 1H), 3.32 (s, 3H), 2.40 (m, 1H), 1.90-2.12
(m, 3H), 1.83 (m, 1H), 1.55-1.70 (m, 2H), 1.26-1.43 (m, 2H), 0.71-0.83 (m, 1H) ppm.
(1R,2E)-Cyclooct-2-en-1-yl N-(4-{[(2-{2-[2-(2,5-dioxo-2,5-dihydro-1H-pyrrol-1-yl)ethoxy]ethoxy}ethyl)carbamoyl]
(hydroxy)methyl}phenyl)-N-methylcarbamate (1.26)
[0640]

[0641] The TFA salt of 1-{2-[2-(2-aminoethoxy)ethoxy]ethyl}-2,5-dihydro-1H-pyrrole-2,5-dione
(46.2 mg, 135.0 µmol), PyBOP (73.2 mg, 148.5 µmol), and DiPEA (117.6 µL, 675 µmol)
were added to
1.25 (50 mg, ca. 135 µmol) in MeCN/CH
2Cl
2 followed by stirring for 15 min. Compound
1.26 was isolated after silica gel column chromatography (CH
2Cl
2 / MeOH, 98:2 to 97:3). Yield: 68% (50 mg, 92 µmol). ESI-MS: m/z calc for C
28H
37N
3O
8 543.26; Obs. [M-H]
+ 542.48.
1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl
3): δ 7.57 (t, J = 5.6 Hz, 1H), 7.42 (d, J = 8.4 Hz, 2H), 7.23 (d, J = 8.4 Hz, 2H),
6.71 (s, 2H), 6.60 (bs, 1H), 5.48 (d, J = 15.8 Hz, 1H), 5.33 (bs, 1H), 5.03 (bs, 1H),
3.70-3.74 (m, 6H), 3.61-3.66 (m, 4H), 3.57-3.60 (m, 2H), 3.50-3.55 (m, 4H), 3.40-3.42
(m, 2H), 3.28 (s, 3H), 2.38 (bs, 1H), 1.9-2.05 (m, 3H), 1.77-1.85 (m, 1H), 1.52-1.69
(m, 4H), 1.26-1.43 (m, 2H), 0.80-0.87 (m, 1H) ppm.
TCO-Mandelic-(PEG2-Mal)-(PEG4-DOTAGA) (1.27)
[0642]

[0643] 1.26 is treated with DSC (1.5 eq.) and DiPEA (3 eq.) in dry DMSO for 4 days at rt followed
by the addition of 4-[(14-amino-3,6,9,12-tetraoxatetradecan-1-yl)carbamoyl]-2-[4,7,10-tris(carboxymethyl)-1,4,7,10-tetraazacyclododecan-1-yl]butanoic
acid HCl salt (2.5 eq) and DiPEA (7 eq) and stirring for 1 h at rt. Following acidification,
preparative HPLC (a H
2O/MeCN gradient with 0.1% TFA) and lyophilization yields the named compound.
DOTAGA-PEG4-TCO-PEG2-Mal (1.28)
[0644]

[0645] 1.1 (1.0 eq) is treated with the TFA salt of 1-{2-[2-(2-aminoethoxy) ethoxy] ethyl}-2,5-dihydro-1H-pyrrole-2,5-dione
(1.1 eq), and DiPEA (3 eq.) in DMSO for 3 h. 2,2',2"-(10-(1-amino-19-carboxy-16-oxo-3,6,9,12-tetraoxa-15-azanonadecan-19-yl)-1,4,7,10-tetraazacyclododecane-1,4,7-triyl)triacetic
acid hydrochloride (1.1 eq) and DiPEA (3 eq) is added and the reaction mixture is
stirred for 16 h at rt. Preparative HPLC (a H
2O/MeCN gradient with 0.1% TFA) and lyophilization, yields the named compound.
Mal-PEG9-TCO-Sar-PEG4-DFO (1.29)
[0646]

[0647] 1.16 is treated with PyBOP (1.1 eq) and DiPEA (3 eq) in dry DMSO for 15 min prior to addition
of desferrioxamine mesylate salt (1.1 eq) and additional DiPEA (3 eq). After 1 h,
and
N-(29-amino-3,6,9,12,15,18,21,24,27-nonaoxanonacosyl)-3-(2,5-dioxo-2,5-dihydro-1
H-pyrrol-1-yl)propanamide TFA salt (1.1 eq) is added and the reaction mixture is stirred
for 16 h. Acidification, preparative HPLC (a H
2O/MeCN gradient with 0.1% TFA) and lyophilization, yields the named compound.
NHS-TCO-PEG4-DOTA (1.30)
[0648]

[0649] A solution of 2-(4-{[(14-amino-3,6,9,12-tetraoxatetradecan-1-yl)carbamoyl] methyl}-7,
10-bis(carboxymethyl)-1,4,7,10-tetraazacyclododecan-1-yl)acetic acid (1.1 eq.) and
DiPEA (6 eq) in MQ-H
2O is added to a solution of
1.1 (1.0 eq) in MeCN and the reaction mixture is stirred for 5 min prior to acidification
and prep purification to yield the title compound after lyophilization.
NHS-TCO-PEG2-HOPO (1.31)
[0650]

[0651] 1.1 (1 eq) is treated with amino-PEG
2-NH
2 (1 eq.) and DiPEA (2 eq) in MeCN for 5 min at rt prior to acidification and prep
purification to yield the intermediate compound (TFA salt) after lyophilization. The
intermediate is dissolved and treated with 1-hydroxy-N-{4-[1-(1-hydroxy-6-oxo-1,6-dihydropyridin-2-yl)-N-{3-[1-(1-hydroxy-6-oxo-1,6-dihydropyridin-2-yl)-N-[2-(4-isothio
cyanatophenyl)ethyl] formamido]propyl}formamido]butyl}-N-{3-[(1-hydroxy-6-oxo-1,6-dihydropyridin-2-yl)formamido]propyl}-6-oxo-1,6-dihydropyridine-2-carboxamide
[
Bhupathiraju et al., Org Biomol Chem 2019, 17, 6866-6871] (1.1 eq) and DiPEA (3 eq) in DMSO for 18 h prior to acidification and prep purification
to yield the title compound after lyophilization.
Example 2: Synthesis of tetrazine Cleaving Agents
[0652] Tetrazines
2.15 and
2.16 where purchased from commercial sources. Tetrazines
2.13,
2.14,
2.17,
2.18 (10 kDa dextrane), and
2.19 were prepared according to literature procedures [
Versteegen et al., Angew Chem Int Ed 2013, 53, 14112;
Rossin et al. Bioconjug Chem 2016, 27, 1697;
Fan et al., Angew Chem Int Ed 2016, 55, 14046], while
2.20,
2.21, and
2.22 were prepared as reported in
WO2019212356 (therein: compounds 2.12, 4.12, 4.28).

2,2'-(1,2,4,5-Tetrazine-3,6-diyl)bis(pyridin-3-ol) (2.1)
[0653]

[0654] 3-Hydroxypicolinonitrile (100 mg, 0.82 mmol) and hydrazine hydrate (280 µL, 4.9 mmol,
6 eq) were stirred at 90°C for 2 h. Ethanol (4 mL) was added and the suspension was
stirred at rt for 5 min. The suspension was filtrated and the solid was washed with
ethanol (5×2 mL). Drying of the solid in vacuo yielded pure intermediate [2H]-TZ (59
mg, 0.22 mmol, 54 %) as a yellow solid. The [2H]-TZ was suspended in acetic acid (6
mL) and NaNO
2 (75 mg, 1.1 mmol, 5 eq) in water (500 µL) was added dropwise. The suspension was
stirred at rt for 1 h during which a clear red solution was obtained and, eventually,
a red precipitate arose. Chloroform and water (both 40 mL) were added and the layers
were separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with chloroform (2×20 mL) and the
combined organic layers were dried using Na
2SO
4. After filtration, the filtrate was evaporated to dryness yielding pure
2.1 (55 mg, 0.21 mmol, 50 % overall) as a red solid.
1H-NMR (DMSO-d6): δ = 10.74 (br s, 2H, O
H), 8.38 (m, 2H, Ar
H), 7.57 (m, 4H, Ar
H) ppm.
13C-NMR (DMSO-d6):
δ = 164.3, 154.3, 141.4, 137.5, 127.5, 125.3 ppm. ESI-MS:
m/
z Calc. for C
12H
8N
6O
2 268.07; Obs. [M+H]
+ 269.17, [M+Na]
+ 291.25.
4,4'-(1,2,4,5-Tetrazine-3,6-diyl)bis(pyridin-3-ol) (2.2)
[0655]

[0656] 3-Hydroxyisonicotinonitrile (62 mg, 0.52 mmol), Zn(OTf)
2 (10 mg, 28 µmol, 0.05 eq), ethanol (80 µL) and hydrazine hydrate (300 µL, 5.3 mmol,
10 eq) were stirred at 60°C for 21 h. After removal of the volatiles in vacuo the
solid was stirred in methanol (4 mL) for 5 min at rt. The suspension was filtrated,
the solid was washed with methanol (5×2 mL) and dried in vacuo yielding impure intermediate
[2H]-TZ as an orange solid. The [2H]-TZ was stirred in acetic acid (4 mL) and NaNO
2 (32 mg, 0.45 mmol) in water (200 µL) was added dropwise causing an immediate color
change from orange to red. After stirring at rt for 1 h the suspension was filtrated,
the solid was washed with ethanol, water and ethanol (all 5×2 mL) and dried in vacuo.
This yielded
2.2 (10 mg, 37 µmol, 14 % overall) as a red solid.
1H-NMR (DMSO-d6):
δ = 10.89 (br, 2H, O
H), 8.56 (s, 2H, Ar
H), 8.37 (d, 2H, Ar
H), 8.04 (d, 2H, ArH) ppm. ESI-MS:
m/
z Calc. for C
12H
8N
6O
2 268.07; Obs. [M+H]
+ 269.17.
2,2'-(1,2,4,5-tetrazine-3,6-diyl)bis(pyridin-3-amine) (2.3)
[0657]

[0658] 3-Aminopicolinonitrile (125 mg, 1.0 mmol) and hydrazine hydrate (300 µL, 5.0 mmol,
5 eq) were stirred at 100°C for 20 h. Cold water (2 mL) was added and the suspension
was stirred at rt for 5 min. Filtration, washing of the solid with cold water and
cold ethanol (both 5×2 mL) and drying in vacuo yielded the intermediate [2H]-TZ (38
mg, 0.14 mmol, 27 %) as an orange solid. To the [2H]-TZ and PhI(OAc)
2 (75 mg, 0.23 mmol, 1.6 eq) dichloromethane (1 mL) was added and the suspension was
stirred at rt for 3 h. In time a color change occurred from orange to red. The suspension
was filtrated, the solid was washed with dichloromethane (5×1 mL) and dried in vacuo
yielding pure
2.3 (31 mg, 0.12 mmol, 22 % overall) as a red solid.
1H-NMR (DMSO-d6):
δ = 8.13 (dd, 2H, Ar
H), 7.36 (2dd, 4H, Ar
H), 6.98 (br s, 4H, N
H2) ppm.
13C-NMR (DMSO-d6): δ = 162.8, 146.6, 138.3, 129.5, 126.9, 124.5 ppm. ESI-MS:
m/
z Calc. for C
12H
10N
8 266.10; Obs. [M+H]
+ 267.08, [2M+H]
+ 532.92, [2M+Na]
+ 555.00.
N,N'-(2,2'-(1,2,4,5-Tetrazine-3,6-diyl)bis(pyridine-3,2-diyl))diacetamide (2.4)
[0659]

[0660] 2.3 (12 mg, 45 µmol) was suspended in acetic anhydride (0.5 mL) and the suspension was
heated at 50°C for 3 days. The mixture was precipitated in diethyl ether (6 mL) and
the solution was decanted. The solid was washed with diethyl ether (2 mL) and the
solution was decanted, after which the wash step was repeated. Next, the solid was
triturated with water (2 mL), the mixture was centrifuged at 12.7 krpm for 1 min and
the solution was decanted. The solid was subsequently dissolved in methanol (1 mL),
after which non-dissolved impurities were removed by filtration. The filtrate was
evaporated to dryness and the obtained residue was triturated with water (2 mL). After
centrifugation at 12.7 krpm for 1 min and decantation, the solid was dried in vacuo
yielding
2.4 (0.75 mg, 2.1 µmol, 5 %) as a purple-red solid. ESI-MS:
m/
z Calc. for C
16H
14N
8O
2 350.12; Obs. [M+H]
+ 351.17, [2M+Na]
+ 722.92.
4,4'-(1,2,4,5-tetrazine-3,6-diyl)bis(pyridin-3-amine) (2.5)
[0661]

[0662] 3-Aminoisonicotinonitrile (200 mg, 1.6 mmol), S (26 mg, 0.8 mmol, 0.5 eq) and hydrazine
hydrate (460 µL, 8.1 mmol, 5 eq) were stirred at 100°C for 16 h. Cold water (2 mL)
was added and the suspension was stirred at rt for 5 min. The suspension was filtrated
and the solid was washed with cold water and cold ethanol (both 5×4 mL). Trituration
in ethanol (20 mL) at 50°C followed by filtration, washing of the solid with ethanol
(5×4 mL) and drying in vacuo yielded the intermediate [2H]-TZ (144 mg, 0.54 mmol,
67 %) as an orange solid. The [2H]-TZ was stirred in DMSO (5 mL) at 40°C while bubbling
through O
2. In time a color change occurred from orange to red. After stirring for 16 h the
reaction mixture was added dropwise to water (70 mL) and the resulting suspension
was filtrated. The solid was washed with water, ethanol and dichloromethane (all 5×4
mL) and dried in vacuo yielding pure
2.5 (130 mg, 0.49 mmol, 61 % overall) as a red solid.
1H-NMR (DMSO-d6):
δ = 8.40 (br s, 2H, Ar
H), 8.20 (d, 2H, Ar
H), 7.95 (br d, 2H, Ar
H), 7.16 (br s, 4H, N
H2) ppm.
13C-NMR (DMSO-d6):
δ = 162.7, 144.3 (br), 141.3, 135.9, 120.8 (br), 115.9 ppm. ESI-MS:
m/
z Calc. for C
12H
10N
8 266.10; Obs. [M+H]
+ 267.17.
N,N'-(4,4'-(1,2,4,5-Tetrazine-3,6-diyl)bis(pyridine-4,3-diyl))diacetamide (2.6)
[0663]

[0664] 2.5 (22 mg, 83 µmol) was suspended in acetic anhydride (0.5 mL) and the suspension was
heated at 50°C for 3 days. The mixture was precipitated in diethyl ether (6 mL) and
the solution was decanted. Next, the solid was triturated with water (2 mL), the mixture
was centrifuged at 12.7 krpm for 1 min and the solution was decanted. This trituration-centrifugation
procedure was repeated using methanol and 2-propanol (both 2 mL). The resulting solid
was dried in vacuo yielding pure
2.6 (12 mg, 34 µmol, 41 %) as a purple-red solid.
1H-NMR (DMSO-d6):
δ = 10.35 (s, 2H, N
H), 9.01 (s, 2H, ArH), 8.67 (d, 2H, Ar
H), 8.02 (d, 2H, Ar
H), 2.00 (s, 6H, C
H3) ppm.
13C-NMR (DMSO-d6):
δ = 168.7, 164.1, 146.4, 146.1, 132.4, 131.4, 123.7, 23.3 ppm. ESI-MS:
m/
z Calc. for C
16H
14N
8O
2 350.12; Obs. [M+H]
+ 351.17.
5,5'-((2,2'-(1,2,4,5-Tetrazine-3,6-diyl)bis(pyridine-3,2-diyl))bis(azanediyl))bis(5-oxopentanoic
acid) (2.7)
[0665]

[0666] 3-Aminopicolinonitrile (0.62 g, 5.2 mmol), 3-mercaptopropionic acid (0.46 mL, 5.2
mmol, 1 eq) and hydrazine hydrate (1.8 mL, 32 mmol, 6 eq) were stirred at 90°C for
18 h. Cold water (2 mL) was added and the suspension was stirred at rt for 5 min.
Filtration, washing of the solid with cold water and cold ethanol (both 5×2 mL) and
drying in vacuo yielded the intermediate [2H]-TZ (0.66 g, 2.4 mmol, 94%) as an orange
solid. [2H]-TZ (200 mg, 0.75 mmol) and glutaric anhydride (0.9 g, 7.5 mmol, 10 eq)
were suspended in dry THF (3 mL). Upon stirring at 52°C the suspension cleared and
the mixture was stirred at 52°C for 19 h. The obtained suspension was filtrated and
the resulting solid was washed with diethyl ether (3×4 mL). The solid was transferred
to a round-bottom flask and the solvent was removed in vacuo. The compound was suspended
in acetic acid (8 mL) and concentrated nitric acid (6 drops) was added dropwise (CAUTION:
toxic fumes). The initially orange suspension turned red in seconds and the mixture
was stirred at rt for 30 min. The suspension was filtrated and the resulting solid
was washed with acetic acid (3×4 mL) and diethyl ether (3×4 mL). The solid was dried
in vacuo at 35°C for 2 h yielding pure
2.7 (327 mg, 0.66 mmol, 89%) as a red solid.
1H-NMR (DMSO-d6):
δ = 10.15 (s, 2H, N
H), 8.65 (dd, 2H, Ar
H), 8.32 (dd, 2H, Ar
H), 7.71 (dd, 2H, Ar
H), 2.27 (t, 4H, C
H2), 2.22 (t, 4H, C
H2), 1.70 (qn, 4H, CH
2C
H2CH
2) ppm.
13C-NMR (DMSO-d6):
δ = 174.1, 171.0, 164.5, 145.8, 142.2, 134.5, 132.0, 126.1, 35.0, 32.8, 20.1 ppm. ESI-MS:
m/
z Calc. for C
22H
22N
8O
6 494.17; Obs. [M+H]
+ 495.33, λ
max = 240, 328 and 525 nm.
N1,N1'-(2,2'-(1,2,4,5-Tetrazine-3,6-diyl)bis(pyridine-3,2-diyl))bis(N5-(29-hydroxy-3,6,9,12,15,18,21,24,27-nonaoxanonacosyl)glutaramide) (2.8)
[0667]

[0668] 2.7 (32.7 mg, 66 µmοl) and 29-amino-3,6,9, 12, 15, 18,21,24,27-nonaoxanonacosan-1-ol
(64.1 mg, 0.14 mmol, 2.1 eq) were suspended in DMF (0.6 mL). A solution of PyBOP (92
mg, 0.17 mmol, 2.6 eq) in DMF (0.5 mL) and N-methylmorpholine (44 µL, 0.40 mmol, 6
eq) were added. The mixture was stirred at rt for 2 h during which the suspension
eventually cleared. Column chromatography (flash SiO
2) using an elution gradient of 8% to 16% methanol in chloroform yielded impure product.
The compound was dissolved in chloroform (60 mL, with some added methanol) and washed
with water / brine 1:1 (30 mL). The organic layer was dried with Na
2SO
4, the mixture was filtrated and the solution was evaporated to dryness. This yielded
pure
2.8 (57 mg, 41 µmοl, 63%) as a red sticky solid.
1H-NMR (DMSO-d6):
δ = 10.16 (s, 2H, ArN
H), 8.65 (dd, 2H, Ar
H), 8.33 (dd, 2H, ArH), 7.79 (t, 2H, N
HCH
2), 7.71 (dd, 2H, Ar
H), 4.54 (t, 2H, O
H), 3.53-3.33 (m, 76H, OC
H2), 3.16 (m, 4H, NHC
H2), 2.23 (t, 4H, C
H2), 2.07 (t, 4H, C
H2), 1.70 (qn, 4H, CH
2C
H2CH
2) ppm. ESI-MS:
m/
z Calc. for C
62H
104N
10O
24 1372.72; Obs. [2M+H]
+ 687.58, [M+H]
+ 1373.83, λ
max = 242 and 524 nm.
5,5'-((4,4'-(1,2,4,5-Tetrazine-3,6-diyl)bis(pyridine-4,3-diyl))bis(azanediyl))bis(5-oxopentanoic
acid) (2.9)
[0669]

[0670] 3-Aminoisonicotinonitrile (200 mg, 1.6 mmol), S (26 mg, 0.8 mmol, 0.5 eq) and hydrazine
hydrate (0.46 mL, 8.1 mmol, 5 eq) were stirred at 100°C for 16 h. Cold water (2 mL)
was added and the suspension was stirred at rt for 5 min. The suspension was filtrated
and the solid was washed with cold water and cold ethanol (both 5×4 mL). Trituration
of the solid in ethanol (20 mL) at 50°C for 15 min was followed by filtration. The
solid was washed with ethanol (5×4 mL) and dried in vacuo yielding the intermediate
[2H]-TZ (144 mg, 0.54 mmol, 67%) as an orange solid. The [2H]-TZ (200 mg, 0.75 mmol)
and glutaric anhydride (0.9 g, 7.5 mmol, 10 eq) were suspended in dry THF (2 mL) and
the mixture was stirred under an Ar atmosphere at 52°C for 14 days. In time, the reaction
mixture turned into a paste and additional THF was occasionally added to ensure that
stirring continued. After
1H-NMR confirmed close to full conversion the paste was transferred to a round-bottom
flask and the solvent was removed in vacuo. The compound was suspended in acetic acid
(20 mL) and concentrated nitric acid (0.75 mL) was added dropwise (CAUTION: toxic
fumes). The initially orange suspension turned red in seconds and the mixture was
stirred at rt for 30 min. The suspension was filtrated and the resulting solid was
washed with acetic acid (3×4 mL). The solid was thoroughly broken up using a spatula,
washed with diethyl ether (3×4 mL) and dried in vacuo at 30°C for 1 h. The dry solid
was powdered using a spatula and stirred in methanol (6 mL) at rt for 30 min. The
suspension was filtrated and the resulting solid was washed with methanol (2×8 mL)
and diethyl ether (5×8 mL). The solid was dried in vacuo at 30°C for 1 h yielding
2.9 (313 mg, 0.63 mmol, 85%) as a pink solid.
1H-NMR (DMSO-d6):
δ = 10.41 (s, 2H, N
H), 9.05 (s, 2H, Ar
H), 8.67 (d, 2H, Ar
H), 8.04 (d, 2H, Ar
H), 2.33 (t, 4H, C
H2), 2.24 (t, 4H, C
H2), 1.72 (qn, 4H, CH
2C
H2CH
2) ppm.
13C-NMR (DMSO-d6):
δ = 174.1, 171.2, 164.0, 145.1, 144.8, 132.9, 131.9, 124.3, 35.0, 32.8, 20.1 ppm. ESI-MS:
m/
z Calc. for C
22H
22N
8O
6 494.17; Obs. [M+H]
+ 495.33, λ
max = 240, 328 and 525 nm.
N1,N1'-(4,4'-(1,2,4,5-Tetrazine-3,6-diyl)bis(pyridine-4,3-diyl))bis(N5-(29-hydroxy-3,6,9,12,15,18,21,24,27-nonaoxanonacosyl)glutaramide) (2.10)
[0671]

[0672] 2.9 (27.5 mg, 56 µmol) and 29-amino-3,6,9, 12, 15, 18,21,24,27-nonaoxanonacosan-1-ol
(53.5 mg, 0.12 mmol, 2.1 eq) were suspended in DMF (0.5 mL). A solution of PyBOP (75
mg, 0.14 mmol, 2.5 eq) in DMF (0.4 mL) and N-methylmorpholine (37 µL, 0.33 mmol, 6
eq) were added. The mixture was stirred at rt for 90 min during which the suspension
eventually cleared. Column chromatography (flash SiO
2) using an elution gradient of 10% to 20% methanol in chloroform yielded impure product.
The compound was dissolved in chloroform (40 mL, with some added methanol) and washed
with water / brine 1:1 (25 mL). The organic layer was dried with Na
2SO
4, the mixture was filtrated and the solution was evaporated to dryness. This yielded
pure
2.10 (36 mg, 56 µmοl, 47%) as a red sticky solid.
1H-NMR (DMSO-d6): δ = 10.35 (s, 2H, ArN
H), 9.05 (s, 2H, Ar
H), 8.66 (d, 2H, Ar
H), 8.02 (d, 2H, Ar
H), 7.80 (t, 2H, N
HCH
2), 4.54 (t, 2H, O
H), 3.53-3.34 (m, 76H, OC
H2), 3.17 (q, 4H, N
HCH
2), 2.29 (t, 4H, C
H2), 2.09 (t, 4H, C
H2), 1.72 (qn, 4H, CH
2C
H2CH
2) ppm.
13C-NMR (CDCl
3):
δ = 172.56, 171.54, 163.89, 145.73, 145.29, 133.81, 128.16, 122.44, 72.35, 70.5 - 69.7
(m), 61.50, 39.18, 36.56, 34.95, 21.30 ppm. ESI-MS:
m/
z Calc. for C
62H
104N
10O
24 1372.72; Obs. [2M+H]
+ 687.75, [M+H]
+ 1373.75, λ
max = 237 and 526 nm.
Tetrazine-bis-GalNAc (with clearance directing groups) (2.11)
[0673]

[0674] 1-[4-(1,2,4,5-Tetrazin-3-yl)phenyl]methanamine (15.9 mg, 65.0 µmol) was treated with
2,6-bis[3-(prop-2-yn-1-yloxy)propanamido]hexanoic acid (23.8 mg, 65.0), HBTU (24.7
mg, 65.1 µmol) and TEA (13.6 µL, 97.6 µmol) in DMF for 4 h followed by partitioning
with CH
2Cl
2 and H
2O. The organic phase was washed with 0.1M HCl, 0.1 M NaOH, H
2O, and brine prior to drying over Na
2SO
4 and concentration. The tetrazine-bis-alkyn intermediate (5 mg, 9 µmol) was treated
with N-[(3R,4R,5R,6R)-2-{2-[2-(2-azidoethoxy)ethoxy] ethoxy}-4,5-dihydroxy-6-(hydroxymethyl)oxan-3-yl]acetamide
(9 mg, 23 µmol) TEA (1 µL, 9 µmol) and CuI (3 mg, 18 µmol) in DMF/H
2O for two hours at rt. Preparative HPLC (a H
2O/MeCN gradient with 0.1% TFA) and lyophilization gave
2.11 in 40% yield (4.7 mg, 3.6 µmol). ESI-MS: m/z calc for C
55H
85N
15O
21 1291.60; Obs [M+H]
+ 1292.12, [M+2H]
+ 646.64.
Synthesis of tetrazine-albumin-galactose Cleaving Agent (with clearance directing
groups) (2.12)
[0675]

[0676] 5-(((6-Methyl-1,2,4,5-tetrazin-3-yl)methyl)amino)-5-oxopentanoic acid [
Bioconjug Chem 2016, 27, 1697-1706] (0.22 mg; 7.56 µmol) was activated with EDC and s-NHS in water following the protocol
provided by the EDC and s-NHS manufacturer (Thermo Fisher) and then purified through
a desalting cartridge. The solution was then added to 3 mg of a mouse albumin-galactose
conjugate (prepared as reported in
Rossin et al., J Nucl Med 2013, 54, 1989-1995) in PBS at pH 9.0 (750 ml total). The mixture was incubated at rt for 30 min and
then it was transferred into an Amicon Ultra-15 centrifugal filter (30 kDa MW cut-off)
where product
2.12 was washed extensively with water. After freeze-drying, the albumin modification
grade was determined by MALDI-TOF analysis. MSA: [M+H]
+ = 65941 m/z; MSA-Gal: [M+H]
+ = 69302 m/z; TZ-MSA-Gal: [M+H]
+ = 72001 m/z, corresponding to 14.2 galactose and 12.2 tetrazine moieties per albumin
molecule.
Example 3: Antibody conjugation and radiolabeling
[0677] The mAbs CC49, rituximab, cetuximab, trastuzumab, and girentuximab were functionalized
with
1.2,
1.4,
1.6,
1.7,
1.14,
1.15 and
1.17 using standard lysine conjugation procedures. Briefly, mAb solutions in PBS (4 mg/mL
final concentration) were added with 15-20 eq of the NHS-derivative (dissolved at
10 mg/mL in DMSO) and the pH was adjusted to 9 with 1M sodium carbonate. The reaction
mixtures were incubated at rt in the dark for 2h then the products were purified by
dialysis (20 kDa MW cut-off membranes) in chelex-treated 0.25M NH
4OAc pH 5.5. The same mAbs were also functionalized with
1.8 and
1.18 using two different procedures: 1) partial reduction of the mAb hinge with TCEP (3
eq, 2h at rt) in 25 mM borate buffer pH 8.0 (containing 1 mM DTPA) or 2) lysine functionalization
with SATA (4 eq) followed by deprotection with hydroxylamine, according to the protocol
provided by the SATA manufacturer (Thermo Fisher Scientific). In both cases, the obtained
free -SH groups were then reacted with
1.8 or
1.18 (20 eq with respect to mAb) overnight at +4°C, and the mAb conjugates were purified
by dialysis in chelex-treated PBS. After dialysis, all mAb conjugates were characterized
by SEC and SDS-PAGE and an average of 2-3 TCO groups were measured per mAb using a
tetrazine titration, as previously published [
Rossin et al., Angew Chem Int Ed 2010, 49, 3375-3378]. The mAbs functionalized with TCO-DOTA derivatives (typically 50-100 µg) were radiolabeled
with
111In and
177Lu (typically 5-10 MBq) in 0.25 NH
4OAc pH 5.5 (also in presence of 0.5M MES buffer pH 5.5 for
111In) at 37°C for 1h in the dark, obtaining 50-70% labeling yields as confirmed by radio-ITLC.
The mAbs functionalized with TCO-DFO derivatives (typically 50-100 µg) were radiolabeled
with
89Zr following established protocols [
Vosjan et al., Nature Protocols 2010, 5, 739-743], obtaining 80-90% labeling yields as confirmed by radio-ITLC. After a 5 min DTPA
challenge, all radiolabeled mAbs were purified using desalting cartridges (Zeba spin
columns, 40 kDa MW cut-off) and were then analyzed by SEC and SDS-PAGE, confirming
>95% radiochemical purity.
Example 4: CC49 conjugation with Trigger 1.22, radiolabeling with I-125 and triggered
1-125 label release in vitro
[0678]

[0679] Maleimide-TCO-TCO
1.21 comprises two TCO moieties that can be selectively manipulated, as the TCO tag on
the outside is ca 20-fold more reactive than the TCO linker, and will preferentially
react with any tetrazine at sub-equimolar conditions. This property was used for the
efficient iodination of a mAb via a cleavable Trigger. CC49 was conjugated with
1.22 using TCEP, as described in Example 3, and the conjugate was labeled via IEDDA conjugation
on the outer TCO tag using a previously described
125I-labeled tetrazine [
Albu et al., Bioconjug Chem 2016, 27, 207-216] in PBS at 37°C for 1h. The crude labeling mixture was purified using a desalting
cartridge (Zeba spin column, 40 kDa MW cut-off). The
125I-labeled CC49 conjugate was subsequently incubated with Cleaving Agent
2.1 for 2h in PBS at 37°C, yielding 88.6% label release (Table 1), as confirmed by SEC
analysis.
Example 5: in vitro Label release from mAb-TCO-chelate conjugates
[0680] mAb conjugates radiolabeled with
111In,
177Lu,
89Zr, or
125I (>95% radiochemical purity at t=0) were reacted with a range of Cleaving Agents
and the Label release was quantified. mAb conjugate (ca. 10 µg) was incubated with
an excess (ca. 30 eq) of Cleaving Agent or without Cleaving Agent in 100 µL PBS or
50% mouse plasma at 37°C. After 15-24 h incubation the mixtures were analyzed by SEC
and the amount of released Label was quantified from the radioactivity elution profile.
The results of the experiments are summarized in Table 1, demonstrating efficient
Label cleavage for a range of different mAbs (and conjugation methods), radionuclides,
Label designs Trigger designs and Cleaving Agents, in physiological conditions.
Table 1: Summary of in vitro Label release from radiolabeled mAb-conjugates after
15-24 h incubation with various Cleaving Agents.
| TCO derivative |
mAb |
radionuclide |
Cleaving Agent |
release (%) |
| 1.2 |
trastuzumab |
111In |
2.1 |
78.2, 88.1a |
| 2.10 |
53.4, 52.2a |
| - |
5.3, 7.4a |
| CC49 |
2.1 |
80.3 |
| girentuximab |
83.2 |
| rituximab |
77.9 |
| cetuximab |
85.7 |
| 1.4 |
trastuzumab |
111In |
2.1 |
81.8a |
| 2.2 |
69.5 |
| 2.10 |
57.9 |
| 2.13 |
62.9a |
| - |
6.8, 7.1a |
| 177Lu |
2.13 |
69.5 |
| 1.6 |
trastuzumab |
111In |
2.1 |
83.6, 68.9a |
| 1.7 |
trastuzumab |
111In |
2.1 |
78.9, 63.4a |
| 1.8 |
trastuzumab |
111In |
2.1 |
86.4, 77.0a |
| 2.2 |
81.6 |
| 2.4 |
54.5a |
| 2.7 |
55.3a |
| 2.8 |
79.9, 60.6a |
| 2.9 |
67.0a |
| 2.10 |
82.4, 82.4a |
| 2.11 |
67.2 |
| 2.12 |
78.3 |
| 2.13 |
71.4 |
| 2.14 |
51.5 |
| 2.16 |
64.5 |
| 2.17 |
53.3 |
| 2.18 |
55.3 |
| 2.19 |
69.1 |
| 2.20 |
67.2 |
| 2.21 |
72.0 |
| 2.22 |
79.0 |
| - |
5.8, 6.6a |
| 177Lu |
2.10 |
81.2 |
| 2.13 |
88.9 |
| 2.22 |
78.9 |
| CC49 |
111In |
2.10 |
79.9 |
| girentuximab |
83.6 |
| rituximab |
82.5 |
| cetuximab |
84.9 |
| 1.14 |
CC49 |
89Zr |
2.1 |
53.0 |
| 2.2 |
60.3 |
| 2.10 |
45.2 |
| 2.13 |
53.6 |
| - |
5.5 |
| 1.15 |
CC49 |
2.1 |
62.3 |
| 2.2 |
65.8 |
| 2.10 |
50.0 |
| 2.13 |
66.3 |
| - |
7.3 |
| 1.17 |
CC49 |
2.1 |
88.0, 81.3a |
| 2.2 |
87.2 |
| 2.10 |
50.0 |
| 2.13 |
72.3 |
| - |
4.2, 7.5a |
| trastuzumab |
2.1 |
88.9 |
| 2.2 |
61.4 |
| 2.13 |
84.4 |
| - |
6.1 |
| 1.22 |
CC49 |
125I |
2.1 |
88.6b |
| a 50% mouse plasma in PBS; b 2h incubation in PBS at 37°C. |
Example 6: Peptide conjugation, radiolabeling and Label cleavage in vitro (Reference
Example)
[0681] Exendin (K
40-Exendin-3 TFA salt, 57.8 nmol) was dissolved in dry DMSO (230 µL), added with DIPEA
(15 eq) and compound
1.2 (1.0 eq) and the mixture was incubated for 2 h at rt in the dark. After incubation,
the reaction mixture was diluted with chelex-treated water (10 mL) and the product
was extracted using two Oasis HLB cartridges and subsequently eluted from the cartridges
with 2×1 mL EtOH. The solvent was evaporated under a stream of N
2 at 45°C, the residue was reconstituted in chelex-treated water. The exendin-
1.2 conjugate (5 µg) was labeled with
111In (12 MBq) in 0.5M MES buffer pH 5.5 at 60°C for 10 min in the dark. After DTPA challenge
(5 min), RP-HPLC analysis confirmed the formation of one major radioactive species
with Rt consistent with peptide. Aliquots of the labeled peptide conjugate solution
were then diluted with PBS and reacted with an excess (ca. 10 eq) of tetrazines
2.1,
2.3,
2.14, and
2.15 or without Cleaving Agent. After overnight incubation at 37°C, RP-HPLC showed the
formation of a more hydrophilic radioactive species (Table 2), which was confirmed
to be
111In-labeled NH
2-PEG4-DOTAGA, signifying cleavage of the TCO Trigger. The same species was not found
when
111In-exendin-
1.2 was incubated overnight in PBS without a tetrazine.
Table 2: Label release (%) from
111In-labeled exendin
-1.2 after ca 15h incubation with various Cleaving Agents.
| Cleaving Agent |
release (%) |
| 2.1 |
85.4 |
| 2.3 |
70.0 |
| 2.14 |
63.0 |
| 2.15 |
54.0 |
| - |
1.0 |
Example 7: In vivo stability of the TCO Trigger
[0682] In two separate experiments, female Balb/C nude mice were injected with
111In-labeled trastuzumab-
1.8 conjugate (ca. 0.5 mg/kg, ca. 1 MBq) and whole blood was withdrawn by heart puncture
24 or 48 h post-mAb injection. Plasma was isolated from blood and analyzed by SEC
to confirm the presence of intact mAb. Plasma aliquots were then reacted ex vivo with
an excess of Cleaving Agent
2.10. After overnight incubation at 37°C, the solutions were again analyzed by SEC and
the fragment (i.e. Label) release % was compared to that achieved in PBS immediately
before injection (t=0). In both cases, the release yield was the same as achieved
at t=0, demonstrating close to 100% retention of TCO reactivity towards tetrazine
after up to 48 h circulation in vivo.
[0683] The same procedure was applied to the plasma obtained from mice that were injected
89Zr-labeled trastuzumab-
1.17 and that were euthanized 1 and 4 days post-mAb injection affording an extrapolated
in vivo deactivation half-life of 12 days.
Example 8: In vivo evaluation of mAb-TCO-Label conjugates in normal mice
[0684] In a preliminary dose finding experiment, two groups of female Balb/C nude mice were
i.v. injected a trastuzumab-
1.2 conjugate labeled with
111In (ca. 5 mg/kg, ca. 1 MBq) followed 1h later by Cleaving Agent
2.1 (ca. 8.4 µmol/kg) or vehicle. Blood samples were withdrawn 5 min before and at various
times after Cleaving Agent administration and the radioactivity was measured in a
gamma-counter. In the mice that received the radiolabeled mAb-TCO conjugate followed
by vehicle the radioactivity levels in blood showed a modest ca. 13% decrease in 1h,
from 30.3±1.2 to 26.2±1.7 %ID/g. On the contrary, the radioactivity circulating in
mice that received the Cleaving Agent showed a rapid ca. 30% decrease from 5 min before
(30.5±1.6 %ID/g) to 60 min after
2.7 injection (20.0±1.1 %ID/g). This enhanced radioactivity clearance signifies the reaction
between the TCO trigger and the Cleaving Agent in circulation followed by release
of the Label, which eliminates rapidly from blood. A higher Cleaving Agent / mAb-conjugate
dose ratio was chosen for follow-up experiments to increase Label release. The
111In-trastuzumab-
1.8 conjugate (ca. 0.5 mg/kg) was administered in 2 more groups of mice followed by
2.10 (ca. 33.5 µmol/kg) either 1h or 24h post-mAb injection. In both cases, Cleaving Agent
administration resulted in ca. 70% reduction in blood radioactivity 24h later (Figure
2) with respect to control mice. Also, lower levels of radioactivity were found in
all non-target organs and tissues (Table 3) including kidney, demonstrating that the
released Label is not preferentially retained in kidney and eliminates from the body
through the urine.
Table 3:
111In biodistribution in mice injected with
111In-trastuzumab-
1.8 followed by
2.10 (or vehicle) 1h or 24h post-mAb injection and euthanized 24h later. Data presented
as % injected dose per gram (or * per organ) with SD (n=4).
| organ |
1h post-mAb |
24h post-mAb |
| Cleaving Agent |
vehicle |
Cleaving Agent |
vehicle |
| Blood |
3.61±0.44 |
12.29±2.08 |
2.91±0.53 |
8.94±1.13 |
| Heart |
0.87±0.10 |
5.12±1.15 |
0.93±0.09 |
2.13±0.27 |
| Lung |
1.94±0.43 |
6.11±0.82 |
2.13±0.41 |
5.18±0.20 |
| Liver |
3.35±0.10 |
6.91±0.84 |
4.68±1.11 |
5.57±1.08 |
| Spleen |
1.19±0.16 |
3.09±0.75 |
1.89±0.17 |
2.78±0.18 |
| Kidney L |
5.39±0.84 |
8.38±1.52 |
4.75±0.45 |
6.02±0.55 |
| Muscle |
0.27±0.02 |
0.74±0.11 |
0.29±0.05 |
0.74±0.06 |
| Bone |
0.44±0.03 |
1.22±0.41 |
0.65±0.03 |
1.12±0.13 |
| Brain |
0.13±0.08 |
0.35±0.14 |
0.11±0.02 |
0.22±0.05 |
| Sm. Intestine* |
0.61±0.04 |
1.76±0.22 |
1.04±0.21 |
1.96±0.24 |
| Lg. intestine* |
0.34±0.07 |
1.35±0.22 |
0.56±0.14 |
1.12±0.38 |
Example 9: In vivo evaluation of trastuzumab-TCO-Label conjugates in tumor-bearing
mice
[0685] Female Balb/C mice were injected ca 1 million LS174T colon carcinoma cells or 10
million BT-474 breast cancer cells s.c. in the flank. When the tumors became palpable,
the mice were injected
111In-trastuzumab-1.8 (ca. 0.5 mg/kg, ca 1 MBq; n=3). One group of LS174T-bearing mice
and one of BT-474 were then administered Cleaving Agent
2.10 (ca. 33.5 µmol/kg) 48h post-injection and were euthanized 24 h later. Control groups
were euthanized 72h post-mAb injection. In control mice, sustained
111In-trastuzumab-1.8 circulation in blood was observed 72h post mAb injection (10-15
%ID/g) and high radioactivity uptake was found in BT-474 tumors (43.3±5.6 %ID/g) and
in LS174T tumors (16.4±1.0). In mice treated with
2.10 somewhat lower radioactivity uptake was found in tumors, most likely due to the fraction
of residual cell-surface bound trastuzumab. However, the Label cleavage in blood resulted
in much lower amounts of radioactivity in blood (2-3% ID/g) and non-target tissues,
therefore affording a significantly improved tumor-to-organ ratios in both tumor models
(Table 4).
Table 4: Tumor-to-nontarget ratios in LS174T and BT-474 tumor-bearing mice treated
with
111In-trastuzumab
-1.8 followed by Cleaving Agent
2.10 and controls.
| |
LS174T |
BT-474 |
| |
control |
Cleaving Agent |
control |
Cleaving Agent |
| Tumor/Blood |
2.1 |
3.7 |
2.8 |
12.0 |
| Tumor/Heart |
6.9 |
10.1 |
10.8 |
13.0 |
| Tumor/Muscle |
23.3 |
27.1 |
37.6 |
88.1 |
[0686] Example 10: Evaluation of 89Zr-labeled CC49-1.17 in tumor-bearing mice Two groups of mice bearing s.c. LS174T colon carcinoma xenografts in the hindlimb
were injected
89Zr-labeled non-internalizing CC49-
1.17 (ca. 0.5 mg/kg, ca. 0.4 MBq) followed 48h later by non-extravasting Cleaving Agent
2.12 (50 µg/mouse) or vehicle, and were euthanized 6h post
2.12 injection. As expected, in mice that were administered the mAb conjugate followed
by vehicle a high
89Zr uptake was found in tumor (47.3 ± 5.2 %ID/g) but elevated radioactivity retention
was found also in blood (14.9 ± 1.8 %ID/g) and non-target organs. On the contrary,
in mice that received
2.12 the
89Zr levels were significantly diminished in blood (3.4 ± 1.2 %ID/g) as well as in other
non-target organs, while the uptake in tumor was mostly retained (41.7 ±7.7 %ID/g).
As a result, significantly improved tumor-to-nontarget ratios can be achieved (Table
5).
Table 5: Tumor-to-nontarget tissues ratio calculated in mice pre-treated with
89Zr-CC49-
1.17 followed by Cleaving Agent
2.12 or vehicle 48h later and euthanized 54h post-mAb injection.
| |
vehicle |
2.12 |
| Tumor/Blood |
3.2 |
12.3 |
| Tumor/Liver |
4.8 |
12.8 |
| Tumor/Kidney |
19.5 |
28.3 |
| Tumor/Muscle |
33.4 |
55.6 |